diff options
author | vitalyisaev <vitalyisaev@ydb.tech> | 2023-11-30 13:26:22 +0300 |
---|---|---|
committer | vitalyisaev <vitalyisaev@ydb.tech> | 2023-11-30 15:44:45 +0300 |
commit | 0a98fece5a9b54f16afeb3a94b3eb3105e9c3962 (patch) | |
tree | 291d72dbd7e9865399f668c84d11ed86fb190bbf /contrib/libs/pcre2/src/pcre2_compile.c | |
parent | cb2c8d75065e5b3c47094067cb4aa407d4813298 (diff) | |
download | ydb-0a98fece5a9b54f16afeb3a94b3eb3105e9c3962.tar.gz |
YQ Connector:Use docker-compose in integrational tests
Diffstat (limited to 'contrib/libs/pcre2/src/pcre2_compile.c')
-rw-r--r-- | contrib/libs/pcre2/src/pcre2_compile.c | 10631 |
1 files changed, 10631 insertions, 0 deletions
diff --git a/contrib/libs/pcre2/src/pcre2_compile.c b/contrib/libs/pcre2/src/pcre2_compile.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..4caeecf6a4 --- /dev/null +++ b/contrib/libs/pcre2/src/pcre2_compile.c @@ -0,0 +1,10631 @@ +/************************************************* +* Perl-Compatible Regular Expressions * +*************************************************/ + +/* PCRE is a library of functions to support regular expressions whose syntax +and semantics are as close as possible to those of the Perl 5 language. + + Written by Philip Hazel + Original API code Copyright (c) 1997-2012 University of Cambridge + New API code Copyright (c) 2016-2022 University of Cambridge + +----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without +modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met: + + * Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, + this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. + + * Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright + notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the + documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. + + * Neither the name of the University of Cambridge nor the names of its + contributors may be used to endorse or promote products derived from + this software without specific prior written permission. + +THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS "AS IS" +AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE +IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE +ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT OWNER OR CONTRIBUTORS BE +LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR +CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF +SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS +INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN +CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) +ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE +POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. +----------------------------------------------------------------------------- +*/ + + +#ifdef HAVE_CONFIG_H +#include <pcre2_config.h> +#endif + +#define NLBLOCK cb /* Block containing newline information */ +#define PSSTART start_pattern /* Field containing processed string start */ +#define PSEND end_pattern /* Field containing processed string end */ + +#include "pcre2_internal.h" + +/* In rare error cases debugging might require calling pcre2_printint(). */ + +#if 0 +#ifdef EBCDIC +#define PRINTABLE(c) ((c) >= 64 && (c) < 255) +#else +#define PRINTABLE(c) ((c) >= 32 && (c) < 127) +#endif +#error #include "pcre2_printint.c" +#define DEBUG_CALL_PRINTINT +#endif + +/* Other debugging code can be enabled by these defines. */ + +/* #define DEBUG_SHOW_CAPTURES */ +/* #define DEBUG_SHOW_PARSED */ + +/* There are a few things that vary with different code unit sizes. Handle them +by defining macros in order to minimize #if usage. */ + +#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 8 +#define STRING_UTFn_RIGHTPAR STRING_UTF8_RIGHTPAR, 5 +#define XDIGIT(c) xdigitab[c] + +#else /* Either 16-bit or 32-bit */ +#define XDIGIT(c) (MAX_255(c)? xdigitab[c] : 0xff) + +#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 16 +#define STRING_UTFn_RIGHTPAR STRING_UTF16_RIGHTPAR, 6 + +#else /* 32-bit */ +#define STRING_UTFn_RIGHTPAR STRING_UTF32_RIGHTPAR, 6 +#endif +#endif + +/* Macros to store and retrieve a PCRE2_SIZE value in the parsed pattern, which +consists of uint32_t elements. Assume that if uint32_t can't hold it, two of +them will be able to (i.e. assume a 64-bit world). */ + +#if PCRE2_SIZE_MAX <= UINT32_MAX +#define PUTOFFSET(s,p) *p++ = s +#define GETOFFSET(s,p) s = *p++ +#define GETPLUSOFFSET(s,p) s = *(++p) +#define READPLUSOFFSET(s,p) s = p[1] +#define SKIPOFFSET(p) p++ +#define SIZEOFFSET 1 +#else +#define PUTOFFSET(s,p) \ + { *p++ = (uint32_t)(s >> 32); *p++ = (uint32_t)(s & 0xffffffff); } +#define GETOFFSET(s,p) \ + { s = ((PCRE2_SIZE)p[0] << 32) | (PCRE2_SIZE)p[1]; p += 2; } +#define GETPLUSOFFSET(s,p) \ + { s = ((PCRE2_SIZE)p[1] << 32) | (PCRE2_SIZE)p[2]; p += 2; } +#define READPLUSOFFSET(s,p) \ + { s = ((PCRE2_SIZE)p[1] << 32) | (PCRE2_SIZE)p[2]; } +#define SKIPOFFSET(p) p += 2 +#define SIZEOFFSET 2 +#endif + +/* Macros for manipulating elements of the parsed pattern vector. */ + +#define META_CODE(x) (x & 0xffff0000u) +#define META_DATA(x) (x & 0x0000ffffu) +#define META_DIFF(x,y) ((x-y)>>16) + +/* Function definitions to allow mutual recursion */ + +#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE +static unsigned int + add_list_to_class_internal(uint8_t *, PCRE2_UCHAR **, uint32_t, + compile_block *, const uint32_t *, unsigned int); +#endif + +static int + compile_regex(uint32_t, PCRE2_UCHAR **, uint32_t **, int *, uint32_t, + uint32_t *, uint32_t *, uint32_t *, uint32_t *, branch_chain *, + compile_block *, PCRE2_SIZE *); + +static int + get_branchlength(uint32_t **, int *, int *, parsed_recurse_check *, + compile_block *); + +static BOOL + set_lookbehind_lengths(uint32_t **, int *, int *, parsed_recurse_check *, + compile_block *); + +static int + check_lookbehinds(uint32_t *, uint32_t **, parsed_recurse_check *, + compile_block *, int *); + + +/************************************************* +* Code parameters and static tables * +*************************************************/ + +#define MAX_GROUP_NUMBER 65535u +#define MAX_REPEAT_COUNT 65535u +#define REPEAT_UNLIMITED (MAX_REPEAT_COUNT+1) + +/* COMPILE_WORK_SIZE specifies the size of stack workspace, which is used in +different ways in the different pattern scans. The parsing and group- +identifying pre-scan uses it to handle nesting, and needs it to be 16-bit +aligned for this. Having defined the size in code units, we set up +C16_WORK_SIZE as the number of elements in the 16-bit vector. + +During the first compiling phase, when determining how much memory is required, +the regex is partly compiled into this space, but the compiled parts are +discarded as soon as they can be, so that hopefully there will never be an +overrun. The code does, however, check for an overrun, which can occur for +pathological patterns. The size of the workspace depends on LINK_SIZE because +the length of compiled items varies with this. + +In the real compile phase, this workspace is not currently used. */ + +#define COMPILE_WORK_SIZE (3000*LINK_SIZE) /* Size in code units */ + +#define C16_WORK_SIZE \ + ((COMPILE_WORK_SIZE * sizeof(PCRE2_UCHAR))/sizeof(uint16_t)) + +/* A uint32_t vector is used for caching information about the size of +capturing groups, to improve performance. A default is created on the stack of +this size. */ + +#define GROUPINFO_DEFAULT_SIZE 256 + +/* The overrun tests check for a slightly smaller size so that they detect the +overrun before it actually does run off the end of the data block. */ + +#define WORK_SIZE_SAFETY_MARGIN (100) + +/* This value determines the size of the initial vector that is used for +remembering named groups during the pre-compile. It is allocated on the stack, +but if it is too small, it is expanded, in a similar way to the workspace. The +value is the number of slots in the list. */ + +#define NAMED_GROUP_LIST_SIZE 20 + +/* The pre-compiling pass over the pattern creates a parsed pattern in a vector +of uint32_t. For short patterns this lives on the stack, with this size. Heap +memory is used for longer patterns. */ + +#define PARSED_PATTERN_DEFAULT_SIZE 1024 + +/* Maximum length value to check against when making sure that the variable +that holds the compiled pattern length does not overflow. We make it a bit less +than INT_MAX to allow for adding in group terminating code units, so that we +don't have to check them every time. */ + +#define OFLOW_MAX (INT_MAX - 20) + +/* Code values for parsed patterns, which are stored in a vector of 32-bit +unsigned ints. Values less than META_END are literal data values. The coding +for identifying the item is in the top 16-bits, leaving 16 bits for the +additional data that some of them need. The META_CODE, META_DATA, and META_DIFF +macros are used to manipulate parsed pattern elements. + +NOTE: When these definitions are changed, the table of extra lengths for each +code (meta_extra_lengths, just below) must be updated to remain in step. */ + +#define META_END 0x80000000u /* End of pattern */ + +#define META_ALT 0x80010000u /* alternation */ +#define META_ATOMIC 0x80020000u /* atomic group */ +#define META_BACKREF 0x80030000u /* Back ref */ +#define META_BACKREF_BYNAME 0x80040000u /* \k'name' */ +#define META_BIGVALUE 0x80050000u /* Next is a literal > META_END */ +#define META_CALLOUT_NUMBER 0x80060000u /* (?C with numerical argument */ +#define META_CALLOUT_STRING 0x80070000u /* (?C with string argument */ +#define META_CAPTURE 0x80080000u /* Capturing parenthesis */ +#define META_CIRCUMFLEX 0x80090000u /* ^ metacharacter */ +#define META_CLASS 0x800a0000u /* start non-empty class */ +#define META_CLASS_EMPTY 0x800b0000u /* empty class */ +#define META_CLASS_EMPTY_NOT 0x800c0000u /* negative empty class */ +#define META_CLASS_END 0x800d0000u /* end of non-empty class */ +#define META_CLASS_NOT 0x800e0000u /* start non-empty negative class */ +#define META_COND_ASSERT 0x800f0000u /* (?(?assertion)... */ +#define META_COND_DEFINE 0x80100000u /* (?(DEFINE)... */ +#define META_COND_NAME 0x80110000u /* (?(<name>)... */ +#define META_COND_NUMBER 0x80120000u /* (?(digits)... */ +#define META_COND_RNAME 0x80130000u /* (?(R&name)... */ +#define META_COND_RNUMBER 0x80140000u /* (?(Rdigits)... */ +#define META_COND_VERSION 0x80150000u /* (?(VERSION<op>x.y)... */ +#define META_DOLLAR 0x80160000u /* $ metacharacter */ +#define META_DOT 0x80170000u /* . metacharacter */ +#define META_ESCAPE 0x80180000u /* \d and friends */ +#define META_KET 0x80190000u /* closing parenthesis */ +#define META_NOCAPTURE 0x801a0000u /* no capture parens */ +#define META_OPTIONS 0x801b0000u /* (?i) and friends */ +#define META_POSIX 0x801c0000u /* POSIX class item */ +#define META_POSIX_NEG 0x801d0000u /* negative POSIX class item */ +#define META_RANGE_ESCAPED 0x801e0000u /* range with at least one escape */ +#define META_RANGE_LITERAL 0x801f0000u /* range defined literally */ +#define META_RECURSE 0x80200000u /* Recursion */ +#define META_RECURSE_BYNAME 0x80210000u /* (?&name) */ +#define META_SCRIPT_RUN 0x80220000u /* (*script_run:...) */ + +/* These must be kept together to make it easy to check that an assertion +is present where expected in a conditional group. */ + +#define META_LOOKAHEAD 0x80230000u /* (?= */ +#define META_LOOKAHEADNOT 0x80240000u /* (?! */ +#define META_LOOKBEHIND 0x80250000u /* (?<= */ +#define META_LOOKBEHINDNOT 0x80260000u /* (?<! */ + +/* These cannot be conditions */ + +#define META_LOOKAHEAD_NA 0x80270000u /* (*napla: */ +#define META_LOOKBEHIND_NA 0x80280000u /* (*naplb: */ + +/* These must be kept in this order, with consecutive values, and the _ARG +versions of COMMIT, PRUNE, SKIP, and THEN immediately after their non-argument +versions. */ + +#define META_MARK 0x80290000u /* (*MARK) */ +#define META_ACCEPT 0x802a0000u /* (*ACCEPT) */ +#define META_FAIL 0x802b0000u /* (*FAIL) */ +#define META_COMMIT 0x802c0000u /* These */ +#define META_COMMIT_ARG 0x802d0000u /* pairs */ +#define META_PRUNE 0x802e0000u /* must */ +#define META_PRUNE_ARG 0x802f0000u /* be */ +#define META_SKIP 0x80300000u /* kept */ +#define META_SKIP_ARG 0x80310000u /* in */ +#define META_THEN 0x80320000u /* this */ +#define META_THEN_ARG 0x80330000u /* order */ + +/* These must be kept in groups of adjacent 3 values, and all together. */ + +#define META_ASTERISK 0x80340000u /* * */ +#define META_ASTERISK_PLUS 0x80350000u /* *+ */ +#define META_ASTERISK_QUERY 0x80360000u /* *? */ +#define META_PLUS 0x80370000u /* + */ +#define META_PLUS_PLUS 0x80380000u /* ++ */ +#define META_PLUS_QUERY 0x80390000u /* +? */ +#define META_QUERY 0x803a0000u /* ? */ +#define META_QUERY_PLUS 0x803b0000u /* ?+ */ +#define META_QUERY_QUERY 0x803c0000u /* ?? */ +#define META_MINMAX 0x803d0000u /* {n,m} repeat */ +#define META_MINMAX_PLUS 0x803e0000u /* {n,m}+ repeat */ +#define META_MINMAX_QUERY 0x803f0000u /* {n,m}? repeat */ + +#define META_FIRST_QUANTIFIER META_ASTERISK +#define META_LAST_QUANTIFIER META_MINMAX_QUERY + +/* This is a special "meta code" that is used only to distinguish (*asr: from +(*sr: in the table of aphabetic assertions. It is never stored in the parsed +pattern because (*asr: is turned into (*sr:(*atomic: at that stage. There is +therefore no need for it to have a length entry, so use a high value. */ + +#define META_ATOMIC_SCRIPT_RUN 0x8fff0000u + +/* Table of extra lengths for each of the meta codes. Must be kept in step with +the definitions above. For some items these values are a basic length to which +a variable amount has to be added. */ + +static unsigned char meta_extra_lengths[] = { + 0, /* META_END */ + 0, /* META_ALT */ + 0, /* META_ATOMIC */ + 0, /* META_BACKREF - more if group is >= 10 */ + 1+SIZEOFFSET, /* META_BACKREF_BYNAME */ + 1, /* META_BIGVALUE */ + 3, /* META_CALLOUT_NUMBER */ + 3+SIZEOFFSET, /* META_CALLOUT_STRING */ + 0, /* META_CAPTURE */ + 0, /* META_CIRCUMFLEX */ + 0, /* META_CLASS */ + 0, /* META_CLASS_EMPTY */ + 0, /* META_CLASS_EMPTY_NOT */ + 0, /* META_CLASS_END */ + 0, /* META_CLASS_NOT */ + 0, /* META_COND_ASSERT */ + SIZEOFFSET, /* META_COND_DEFINE */ + 1+SIZEOFFSET, /* META_COND_NAME */ + 1+SIZEOFFSET, /* META_COND_NUMBER */ + 1+SIZEOFFSET, /* META_COND_RNAME */ + 1+SIZEOFFSET, /* META_COND_RNUMBER */ + 3, /* META_COND_VERSION */ + 0, /* META_DOLLAR */ + 0, /* META_DOT */ + 0, /* META_ESCAPE - more for ESC_P, ESC_p, ESC_g, ESC_k */ + 0, /* META_KET */ + 0, /* META_NOCAPTURE */ + 1, /* META_OPTIONS */ + 1, /* META_POSIX */ + 1, /* META_POSIX_NEG */ + 0, /* META_RANGE_ESCAPED */ + 0, /* META_RANGE_LITERAL */ + SIZEOFFSET, /* META_RECURSE */ + 1+SIZEOFFSET, /* META_RECURSE_BYNAME */ + 0, /* META_SCRIPT_RUN */ + 0, /* META_LOOKAHEAD */ + 0, /* META_LOOKAHEADNOT */ + SIZEOFFSET, /* META_LOOKBEHIND */ + SIZEOFFSET, /* META_LOOKBEHINDNOT */ + 0, /* META_LOOKAHEAD_NA */ + SIZEOFFSET, /* META_LOOKBEHIND_NA */ + 1, /* META_MARK - plus the string length */ + 0, /* META_ACCEPT */ + 0, /* META_FAIL */ + 0, /* META_COMMIT */ + 1, /* META_COMMIT_ARG - plus the string length */ + 0, /* META_PRUNE */ + 1, /* META_PRUNE_ARG - plus the string length */ + 0, /* META_SKIP */ + 1, /* META_SKIP_ARG - plus the string length */ + 0, /* META_THEN */ + 1, /* META_THEN_ARG - plus the string length */ + 0, /* META_ASTERISK */ + 0, /* META_ASTERISK_PLUS */ + 0, /* META_ASTERISK_QUERY */ + 0, /* META_PLUS */ + 0, /* META_PLUS_PLUS */ + 0, /* META_PLUS_QUERY */ + 0, /* META_QUERY */ + 0, /* META_QUERY_PLUS */ + 0, /* META_QUERY_QUERY */ + 2, /* META_MINMAX */ + 2, /* META_MINMAX_PLUS */ + 2 /* META_MINMAX_QUERY */ +}; + +/* Types for skipping parts of a parsed pattern. */ + +enum { PSKIP_ALT, PSKIP_CLASS, PSKIP_KET }; + +/* Macro for setting individual bits in class bitmaps. It took some +experimenting to figure out how to stop gcc 5.3.0 from warning with +-Wconversion. This version gets a warning: + + #define SETBIT(a,b) a[(b)/8] |= (uint8_t)(1u << ((b)&7)) + +Let's hope the apparently less efficient version isn't actually so bad if the +compiler is clever with identical subexpressions. */ + +#define SETBIT(a,b) a[(b)/8] = (uint8_t)(a[(b)/8] | (1u << ((b)&7))) + +/* Values and flags for the unsigned xxcuflags variables that accompany xxcu +variables, which are concerned with first and required code units. A value +greater than or equal to REQ_NONE means "no code unit set"; otherwise the +matching xxcu variable is set, and the low valued bits are relevant. */ + +#define REQ_UNSET 0xffffffffu /* Not yet found anything */ +#define REQ_NONE 0xfffffffeu /* Found not fixed character */ +#define REQ_CASELESS 0x00000001u /* Code unit in xxcu is caseless */ +#define REQ_VARY 0x00000002u /* Code unit is followed by non-literal */ + +/* These flags are used in the groupinfo vector. */ + +#define GI_SET_FIXED_LENGTH 0x80000000u +#define GI_NOT_FIXED_LENGTH 0x40000000u +#define GI_FIXED_LENGTH_MASK 0x0000ffffu + +/* This simple test for a decimal digit works for both ASCII/Unicode and EBCDIC +and is fast (a good compiler can turn it into a subtraction and unsigned +comparison). */ + +#define IS_DIGIT(x) ((x) >= CHAR_0 && (x) <= CHAR_9) + +/* Table to identify hex digits. The tables in chartables are dependent on the +locale, and may mark arbitrary characters as digits. We want to recognize only +0-9, a-z, and A-Z as hex digits, which is why we have a private table here. It +costs 256 bytes, but it is a lot faster than doing character value tests (at +least in some simple cases I timed), and in some applications one wants PCRE2 +to compile efficiently as well as match efficiently. The value in the table is +the binary hex digit value, or 0xff for non-hex digits. */ + +/* This is the "normal" case, for ASCII systems, and EBCDIC systems running in +UTF-8 mode. */ + +#ifndef EBCDIC +static const uint8_t xdigitab[] = + { + 0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 0- 7 */ + 0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 8- 15 */ + 0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 16- 23 */ + 0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 24- 31 */ + 0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* - ' */ + 0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* ( - / */ + 0x00,0x01,0x02,0x03,0x04,0x05,0x06,0x07, /* 0 - 7 */ + 0x08,0x09,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 8 - ? */ + 0xff,0x0a,0x0b,0x0c,0x0d,0x0e,0x0f,0xff, /* @ - G */ + 0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* H - O */ + 0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* P - W */ + 0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* X - _ */ + 0xff,0x0a,0x0b,0x0c,0x0d,0x0e,0x0f,0xff, /* ` - g */ + 0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* h - o */ + 0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* p - w */ + 0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* x -127 */ + 0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 128-135 */ + 0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 136-143 */ + 0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 144-151 */ + 0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 152-159 */ + 0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 160-167 */ + 0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 168-175 */ + 0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 176-183 */ + 0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 184-191 */ + 0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 192-199 */ + 0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 2ff-207 */ + 0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 208-215 */ + 0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 216-223 */ + 0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 224-231 */ + 0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 232-239 */ + 0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 240-247 */ + 0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff};/* 248-255 */ + +#else + +/* This is the "abnormal" case, for EBCDIC systems not running in UTF-8 mode. */ + +static const uint8_t xdigitab[] = + { + 0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 0- 7 0 */ + 0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 8- 15 */ + 0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 16- 23 10 */ + 0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 24- 31 */ + 0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 32- 39 20 */ + 0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 40- 47 */ + 0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 48- 55 30 */ + 0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 56- 63 */ + 0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* - 71 40 */ + 0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 72- | */ + 0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* & - 87 50 */ + 0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 88- 95 */ + 0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* - -103 60 */ + 0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 104- ? */ + 0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 112-119 70 */ + 0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 120- " */ + 0xff,0x0a,0x0b,0x0c,0x0d,0x0e,0x0f,0xff, /* 128- g 80 */ + 0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* h -143 */ + 0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 144- p 90 */ + 0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* q -159 */ + 0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 160- x A0 */ + 0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* y -175 */ + 0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* ^ -183 B0 */ + 0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* 184-191 */ + 0xff,0x0a,0x0b,0x0c,0x0d,0x0e,0x0f,0xff, /* { - G C0 */ + 0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* H -207 */ + 0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* } - P D0 */ + 0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* Q -223 */ + 0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* \ - X E0 */ + 0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff, /* Y -239 */ + 0x00,0x01,0x02,0x03,0x04,0x05,0x06,0x07, /* 0 - 7 F0 */ + 0x08,0x09,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff};/* 8 -255 */ +#endif /* EBCDIC */ + + +/* Table for handling alphanumeric escaped characters. Positive returns are +simple data values; negative values are for special things like \d and so on. +Zero means further processing is needed (for things like \x), or the escape is +invalid. */ + +/* This is the "normal" table for ASCII systems or for EBCDIC systems running +in UTF-8 mode. It runs from '0' to 'z'. */ + +#ifndef EBCDIC +#define ESCAPES_FIRST CHAR_0 +#define ESCAPES_LAST CHAR_z +#define UPPER_CASE(c) (c-32) + +static const short int escapes[] = { + 0, 0, + 0, 0, + 0, 0, + 0, 0, + 0, 0, + CHAR_COLON, CHAR_SEMICOLON, + CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN, CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN, + CHAR_GREATER_THAN_SIGN, CHAR_QUESTION_MARK, + CHAR_COMMERCIAL_AT, -ESC_A, + -ESC_B, -ESC_C, + -ESC_D, -ESC_E, + 0, -ESC_G, + -ESC_H, 0, + 0, -ESC_K, + 0, 0, + -ESC_N, 0, + -ESC_P, -ESC_Q, + -ESC_R, -ESC_S, + 0, 0, + -ESC_V, -ESC_W, + -ESC_X, 0, + -ESC_Z, CHAR_LEFT_SQUARE_BRACKET, + CHAR_BACKSLASH, CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET, + CHAR_CIRCUMFLEX_ACCENT, CHAR_UNDERSCORE, + CHAR_GRAVE_ACCENT, CHAR_BEL, + -ESC_b, 0, + -ESC_d, CHAR_ESC, + CHAR_FF, 0, + -ESC_h, 0, + 0, -ESC_k, + 0, 0, + CHAR_LF, 0, + -ESC_p, 0, + CHAR_CR, -ESC_s, + CHAR_HT, 0, + -ESC_v, -ESC_w, + 0, 0, + -ESC_z +}; + +#else + +/* This is the "abnormal" table for EBCDIC systems without UTF-8 support. +It runs from 'a' to '9'. For some minimal testing of EBCDIC features, the code +is sometimes compiled on an ASCII system. In this case, we must not use CHAR_a +because it is defined as 'a', which of course picks up the ASCII value. */ + +#if 'a' == 0x81 /* Check for a real EBCDIC environment */ +#define ESCAPES_FIRST CHAR_a +#define ESCAPES_LAST CHAR_9 +#define UPPER_CASE(c) (c+64) +#else /* Testing in an ASCII environment */ +#define ESCAPES_FIRST ((unsigned char)'\x81') /* EBCDIC 'a' */ +#define ESCAPES_LAST ((unsigned char)'\xf9') /* EBCDIC '9' */ +#define UPPER_CASE(c) (c-32) +#endif + +static const short int escapes[] = { +/* 80 */ CHAR_BEL, -ESC_b, 0, -ESC_d, CHAR_ESC, CHAR_FF, 0, +/* 88 */ -ESC_h, 0, 0, '{', 0, 0, 0, 0, +/* 90 */ 0, 0, -ESC_k, 0, 0, CHAR_LF, 0, -ESC_p, +/* 98 */ 0, CHAR_CR, 0, '}', 0, 0, 0, 0, +/* A0 */ 0, '~', -ESC_s, CHAR_HT, 0, -ESC_v, -ESC_w, 0, +/* A8 */ 0, -ESC_z, 0, 0, 0, '[', 0, 0, +/* B0 */ 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, +/* B8 */ 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, ']', '=', '-', +/* C0 */ '{', -ESC_A, -ESC_B, -ESC_C, -ESC_D, -ESC_E, 0, -ESC_G, +/* C8 */ -ESC_H, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, +/* D0 */ '}', 0, -ESC_K, 0, 0, -ESC_N, 0, -ESC_P, +/* D8 */ -ESC_Q, -ESC_R, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, +/* E0 */ '\\', 0, -ESC_S, 0, 0, -ESC_V, -ESC_W, -ESC_X, +/* E8 */ 0, -ESC_Z, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, +/* F0 */ 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, +/* F8 */ 0, 0 +}; + +/* We also need a table of characters that may follow \c in an EBCDIC +environment for characters 0-31. */ + +static unsigned char ebcdic_escape_c[] = "@ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ[\\]^_"; + +#endif /* EBCDIC */ + + +/* Table of special "verbs" like (*PRUNE). This is a short table, so it is +searched linearly. Put all the names into a single string, in order to reduce +the number of relocations when a shared library is dynamically linked. The +string is built from string macros so that it works in UTF-8 mode on EBCDIC +platforms. */ + +typedef struct verbitem { + unsigned int len; /* Length of verb name */ + uint32_t meta; /* Base META_ code */ + int has_arg; /* Argument requirement */ +} verbitem; + +static const char verbnames[] = + "\0" /* Empty name is a shorthand for MARK */ + STRING_MARK0 + STRING_ACCEPT0 + STRING_F0 + STRING_FAIL0 + STRING_COMMIT0 + STRING_PRUNE0 + STRING_SKIP0 + STRING_THEN; + +static const verbitem verbs[] = { + { 0, META_MARK, +1 }, /* > 0 => must have an argument */ + { 4, META_MARK, +1 }, + { 6, META_ACCEPT, -1 }, /* < 0 => Optional argument, convert to pre-MARK */ + { 1, META_FAIL, -1 }, + { 4, META_FAIL, -1 }, + { 6, META_COMMIT, 0 }, + { 5, META_PRUNE, 0 }, /* Optional argument; bump META code if found */ + { 4, META_SKIP, 0 }, + { 4, META_THEN, 0 } +}; + +static const int verbcount = sizeof(verbs)/sizeof(verbitem); + +/* Verb opcodes, indexed by their META code offset from META_MARK. */ + +static const uint32_t verbops[] = { + OP_MARK, OP_ACCEPT, OP_FAIL, OP_COMMIT, OP_COMMIT_ARG, OP_PRUNE, + OP_PRUNE_ARG, OP_SKIP, OP_SKIP_ARG, OP_THEN, OP_THEN_ARG }; + +/* Table of "alpha assertions" like (*pla:...), similar to the (*VERB) table. */ + +typedef struct alasitem { + unsigned int len; /* Length of name */ + uint32_t meta; /* Base META_ code */ +} alasitem; + +static const char alasnames[] = + STRING_pla0 + STRING_plb0 + STRING_napla0 + STRING_naplb0 + STRING_nla0 + STRING_nlb0 + STRING_positive_lookahead0 + STRING_positive_lookbehind0 + STRING_non_atomic_positive_lookahead0 + STRING_non_atomic_positive_lookbehind0 + STRING_negative_lookahead0 + STRING_negative_lookbehind0 + STRING_atomic0 + STRING_sr0 + STRING_asr0 + STRING_script_run0 + STRING_atomic_script_run; + +static const alasitem alasmeta[] = { + { 3, META_LOOKAHEAD }, + { 3, META_LOOKBEHIND }, + { 5, META_LOOKAHEAD_NA }, + { 5, META_LOOKBEHIND_NA }, + { 3, META_LOOKAHEADNOT }, + { 3, META_LOOKBEHINDNOT }, + { 18, META_LOOKAHEAD }, + { 19, META_LOOKBEHIND }, + { 29, META_LOOKAHEAD_NA }, + { 30, META_LOOKBEHIND_NA }, + { 18, META_LOOKAHEADNOT }, + { 19, META_LOOKBEHINDNOT }, + { 6, META_ATOMIC }, + { 2, META_SCRIPT_RUN }, /* sr = script run */ + { 3, META_ATOMIC_SCRIPT_RUN }, /* asr = atomic script run */ + { 10, META_SCRIPT_RUN }, /* script run */ + { 17, META_ATOMIC_SCRIPT_RUN } /* atomic script run */ +}; + +static const int alascount = sizeof(alasmeta)/sizeof(alasitem); + +/* Offsets from OP_STAR for case-independent and negative repeat opcodes. */ + +static uint32_t chartypeoffset[] = { + OP_STAR - OP_STAR, OP_STARI - OP_STAR, + OP_NOTSTAR - OP_STAR, OP_NOTSTARI - OP_STAR }; + +/* Tables of names of POSIX character classes and their lengths. The names are +now all in a single string, to reduce the number of relocations when a shared +library is dynamically loaded. The list of lengths is terminated by a zero +length entry. The first three must be alpha, lower, upper, as this is assumed +for handling case independence. The indices for graph, print, and punct are +needed, so identify them. */ + +static const char posix_names[] = + STRING_alpha0 STRING_lower0 STRING_upper0 STRING_alnum0 + STRING_ascii0 STRING_blank0 STRING_cntrl0 STRING_digit0 + STRING_graph0 STRING_print0 STRING_punct0 STRING_space0 + STRING_word0 STRING_xdigit; + +static const uint8_t posix_name_lengths[] = { + 5, 5, 5, 5, 5, 5, 5, 5, 5, 5, 5, 5, 4, 6, 0 }; + +#define PC_GRAPH 8 +#define PC_PRINT 9 +#define PC_PUNCT 10 + +/* Table of class bit maps for each POSIX class. Each class is formed from a +base map, with an optional addition or removal of another map. Then, for some +classes, there is some additional tweaking: for [:blank:] the vertical space +characters are removed, and for [:alpha:] and [:alnum:] the underscore +character is removed. The triples in the table consist of the base map offset, +second map offset or -1 if no second map, and a non-negative value for map +addition or a negative value for map subtraction (if there are two maps). The +absolute value of the third field has these meanings: 0 => no tweaking, 1 => +remove vertical space characters, 2 => remove underscore. */ + +static const int posix_class_maps[] = { + cbit_word, cbit_digit, -2, /* alpha */ + cbit_lower, -1, 0, /* lower */ + cbit_upper, -1, 0, /* upper */ + cbit_word, -1, 2, /* alnum - word without underscore */ + cbit_print, cbit_cntrl, 0, /* ascii */ + cbit_space, -1, 1, /* blank - a GNU extension */ + cbit_cntrl, -1, 0, /* cntrl */ + cbit_digit, -1, 0, /* digit */ + cbit_graph, -1, 0, /* graph */ + cbit_print, -1, 0, /* print */ + cbit_punct, -1, 0, /* punct */ + cbit_space, -1, 0, /* space */ + cbit_word, -1, 0, /* word - a Perl extension */ + cbit_xdigit,-1, 0 /* xdigit */ +}; + +#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE + +/* The POSIX class Unicode property substitutes that are used in UCP mode must +be in the order of the POSIX class names, defined above. */ + +static int posix_substitutes[] = { + PT_GC, ucp_L, /* alpha */ + PT_PC, ucp_Ll, /* lower */ + PT_PC, ucp_Lu, /* upper */ + PT_ALNUM, 0, /* alnum */ + -1, 0, /* ascii, treat as non-UCP */ + -1, 1, /* blank, treat as \h */ + PT_PC, ucp_Cc, /* cntrl */ + PT_PC, ucp_Nd, /* digit */ + PT_PXGRAPH, 0, /* graph */ + PT_PXPRINT, 0, /* print */ + PT_PXPUNCT, 0, /* punct */ + PT_PXSPACE, 0, /* space */ /* Xps is POSIX space, but from 8.34 */ + PT_WORD, 0, /* word */ /* Perl and POSIX space are the same */ + -1, 0 /* xdigit, treat as non-UCP */ +}; +#define POSIX_SUBSIZE (sizeof(posix_substitutes) / (2*sizeof(uint32_t))) +#endif /* SUPPORT_UNICODE */ + +/* Masks for checking option settings. When PCRE2_LITERAL is set, only a subset +are allowed. */ + +#define PUBLIC_LITERAL_COMPILE_OPTIONS \ + (PCRE2_ANCHORED|PCRE2_AUTO_CALLOUT|PCRE2_CASELESS|PCRE2_ENDANCHORED| \ + PCRE2_FIRSTLINE|PCRE2_LITERAL|PCRE2_MATCH_INVALID_UTF| \ + PCRE2_NO_START_OPTIMIZE|PCRE2_NO_UTF_CHECK|PCRE2_USE_OFFSET_LIMIT|PCRE2_UTF) + +#define PUBLIC_COMPILE_OPTIONS \ + (PUBLIC_LITERAL_COMPILE_OPTIONS| \ + PCRE2_ALLOW_EMPTY_CLASS|PCRE2_ALT_BSUX|PCRE2_ALT_CIRCUMFLEX| \ + PCRE2_ALT_VERBNAMES|PCRE2_DOLLAR_ENDONLY|PCRE2_DOTALL|PCRE2_DUPNAMES| \ + PCRE2_EXTENDED|PCRE2_EXTENDED_MORE|PCRE2_MATCH_UNSET_BACKREF| \ + PCRE2_MULTILINE|PCRE2_NEVER_BACKSLASH_C|PCRE2_NEVER_UCP| \ + PCRE2_NEVER_UTF|PCRE2_NO_AUTO_CAPTURE|PCRE2_NO_AUTO_POSSESS| \ + PCRE2_NO_DOTSTAR_ANCHOR|PCRE2_UCP|PCRE2_UNGREEDY) + +#define PUBLIC_LITERAL_COMPILE_EXTRA_OPTIONS \ + (PCRE2_EXTRA_MATCH_LINE|PCRE2_EXTRA_MATCH_WORD) + +#define PUBLIC_COMPILE_EXTRA_OPTIONS \ + (PUBLIC_LITERAL_COMPILE_EXTRA_OPTIONS| \ + PCRE2_EXTRA_ALLOW_SURROGATE_ESCAPES|PCRE2_EXTRA_BAD_ESCAPE_IS_LITERAL| \ + PCRE2_EXTRA_ESCAPED_CR_IS_LF|PCRE2_EXTRA_ALT_BSUX| \ + PCRE2_EXTRA_ALLOW_LOOKAROUND_BSK) + +/* Compile time error code numbers. They are given names so that they can more +easily be tracked. When a new number is added, the tables called eint1 and +eint2 in pcre2posix.c may need to be updated, and a new error text must be +added to compile_error_texts in pcre2_error.c. Also, the error codes in +pcre2.h.in must be updated - their values are exactly 100 greater than these +values. */ + +enum { ERR0 = COMPILE_ERROR_BASE, + ERR1, ERR2, ERR3, ERR4, ERR5, ERR6, ERR7, ERR8, ERR9, ERR10, + ERR11, ERR12, ERR13, ERR14, ERR15, ERR16, ERR17, ERR18, ERR19, ERR20, + ERR21, ERR22, ERR23, ERR24, ERR25, ERR26, ERR27, ERR28, ERR29, ERR30, + ERR31, ERR32, ERR33, ERR34, ERR35, ERR36, ERR37, ERR38, ERR39, ERR40, + ERR41, ERR42, ERR43, ERR44, ERR45, ERR46, ERR47, ERR48, ERR49, ERR50, + ERR51, ERR52, ERR53, ERR54, ERR55, ERR56, ERR57, ERR58, ERR59, ERR60, + ERR61, ERR62, ERR63, ERR64, ERR65, ERR66, ERR67, ERR68, ERR69, ERR70, + ERR71, ERR72, ERR73, ERR74, ERR75, ERR76, ERR77, ERR78, ERR79, ERR80, + ERR81, ERR82, ERR83, ERR84, ERR85, ERR86, ERR87, ERR88, ERR89, ERR90, + ERR91, ERR92, ERR93, ERR94, ERR95, ERR96, ERR97, ERR98, ERR99 }; + +/* This is a table of start-of-pattern options such as (*UTF) and settings such +as (*LIMIT_MATCH=nnnn) and (*CRLF). For completeness and backward +compatibility, (*UTFn) is supported in the relevant libraries, but (*UTF) is +generic and always supported. */ + +enum { PSO_OPT, /* Value is an option bit */ + PSO_FLG, /* Value is a flag bit */ + PSO_NL, /* Value is a newline type */ + PSO_BSR, /* Value is a \R type */ + PSO_LIMH, /* Read integer value for heap limit */ + PSO_LIMM, /* Read integer value for match limit */ + PSO_LIMD }; /* Read integer value for depth limit */ + +typedef struct pso { + const uint8_t *name; + uint16_t length; + uint16_t type; + uint32_t value; +} pso; + +/* NB: STRING_UTFn_RIGHTPAR contains the length as well */ + +static pso pso_list[] = { + { (uint8_t *)STRING_UTFn_RIGHTPAR, PSO_OPT, PCRE2_UTF }, + { (uint8_t *)STRING_UTF_RIGHTPAR, 4, PSO_OPT, PCRE2_UTF }, + { (uint8_t *)STRING_UCP_RIGHTPAR, 4, PSO_OPT, PCRE2_UCP }, + { (uint8_t *)STRING_NOTEMPTY_RIGHTPAR, 9, PSO_FLG, PCRE2_NOTEMPTY_SET }, + { (uint8_t *)STRING_NOTEMPTY_ATSTART_RIGHTPAR, 17, PSO_FLG, PCRE2_NE_ATST_SET }, + { (uint8_t *)STRING_NO_AUTO_POSSESS_RIGHTPAR, 16, PSO_OPT, PCRE2_NO_AUTO_POSSESS }, + { (uint8_t *)STRING_NO_DOTSTAR_ANCHOR_RIGHTPAR, 18, PSO_OPT, PCRE2_NO_DOTSTAR_ANCHOR }, + { (uint8_t *)STRING_NO_JIT_RIGHTPAR, 7, PSO_FLG, PCRE2_NOJIT }, + { (uint8_t *)STRING_NO_START_OPT_RIGHTPAR, 13, PSO_OPT, PCRE2_NO_START_OPTIMIZE }, + { (uint8_t *)STRING_LIMIT_HEAP_EQ, 11, PSO_LIMH, 0 }, + { (uint8_t *)STRING_LIMIT_MATCH_EQ, 12, PSO_LIMM, 0 }, + { (uint8_t *)STRING_LIMIT_DEPTH_EQ, 12, PSO_LIMD, 0 }, + { (uint8_t *)STRING_LIMIT_RECURSION_EQ, 16, PSO_LIMD, 0 }, + { (uint8_t *)STRING_CR_RIGHTPAR, 3, PSO_NL, PCRE2_NEWLINE_CR }, + { (uint8_t *)STRING_LF_RIGHTPAR, 3, PSO_NL, PCRE2_NEWLINE_LF }, + { (uint8_t *)STRING_CRLF_RIGHTPAR, 5, PSO_NL, PCRE2_NEWLINE_CRLF }, + { (uint8_t *)STRING_ANY_RIGHTPAR, 4, PSO_NL, PCRE2_NEWLINE_ANY }, + { (uint8_t *)STRING_NUL_RIGHTPAR, 4, PSO_NL, PCRE2_NEWLINE_NUL }, + { (uint8_t *)STRING_ANYCRLF_RIGHTPAR, 8, PSO_NL, PCRE2_NEWLINE_ANYCRLF }, + { (uint8_t *)STRING_BSR_ANYCRLF_RIGHTPAR, 12, PSO_BSR, PCRE2_BSR_ANYCRLF }, + { (uint8_t *)STRING_BSR_UNICODE_RIGHTPAR, 12, PSO_BSR, PCRE2_BSR_UNICODE } +}; + +/* This table is used when converting repeating opcodes into possessified +versions as a result of an explicit possessive quantifier such as ++. A zero +value means there is no possessified version - in those cases the item in +question must be wrapped in ONCE brackets. The table is truncated at OP_CALLOUT +because all relevant opcodes are less than that. */ + +static const uint8_t opcode_possessify[] = { + 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, /* 0 - 15 */ + 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, /* 16 - 31 */ + + 0, /* NOTI */ + OP_POSSTAR, 0, /* STAR, MINSTAR */ + OP_POSPLUS, 0, /* PLUS, MINPLUS */ + OP_POSQUERY, 0, /* QUERY, MINQUERY */ + OP_POSUPTO, 0, /* UPTO, MINUPTO */ + 0, /* EXACT */ + 0, 0, 0, 0, /* POS{STAR,PLUS,QUERY,UPTO} */ + + OP_POSSTARI, 0, /* STARI, MINSTARI */ + OP_POSPLUSI, 0, /* PLUSI, MINPLUSI */ + OP_POSQUERYI, 0, /* QUERYI, MINQUERYI */ + OP_POSUPTOI, 0, /* UPTOI, MINUPTOI */ + 0, /* EXACTI */ + 0, 0, 0, 0, /* POS{STARI,PLUSI,QUERYI,UPTOI} */ + + OP_NOTPOSSTAR, 0, /* NOTSTAR, NOTMINSTAR */ + OP_NOTPOSPLUS, 0, /* NOTPLUS, NOTMINPLUS */ + OP_NOTPOSQUERY, 0, /* NOTQUERY, NOTMINQUERY */ + OP_NOTPOSUPTO, 0, /* NOTUPTO, NOTMINUPTO */ + 0, /* NOTEXACT */ + 0, 0, 0, 0, /* NOTPOS{STAR,PLUS,QUERY,UPTO} */ + + OP_NOTPOSSTARI, 0, /* NOTSTARI, NOTMINSTARI */ + OP_NOTPOSPLUSI, 0, /* NOTPLUSI, NOTMINPLUSI */ + OP_NOTPOSQUERYI, 0, /* NOTQUERYI, NOTMINQUERYI */ + OP_NOTPOSUPTOI, 0, /* NOTUPTOI, NOTMINUPTOI */ + 0, /* NOTEXACTI */ + 0, 0, 0, 0, /* NOTPOS{STARI,PLUSI,QUERYI,UPTOI} */ + + OP_TYPEPOSSTAR, 0, /* TYPESTAR, TYPEMINSTAR */ + OP_TYPEPOSPLUS, 0, /* TYPEPLUS, TYPEMINPLUS */ + OP_TYPEPOSQUERY, 0, /* TYPEQUERY, TYPEMINQUERY */ + OP_TYPEPOSUPTO, 0, /* TYPEUPTO, TYPEMINUPTO */ + 0, /* TYPEEXACT */ + 0, 0, 0, 0, /* TYPEPOS{STAR,PLUS,QUERY,UPTO} */ + + OP_CRPOSSTAR, 0, /* CRSTAR, CRMINSTAR */ + OP_CRPOSPLUS, 0, /* CRPLUS, CRMINPLUS */ + OP_CRPOSQUERY, 0, /* CRQUERY, CRMINQUERY */ + OP_CRPOSRANGE, 0, /* CRRANGE, CRMINRANGE */ + 0, 0, 0, 0, /* CRPOS{STAR,PLUS,QUERY,RANGE} */ + + 0, 0, 0, /* CLASS, NCLASS, XCLASS */ + 0, 0, /* REF, REFI */ + 0, 0, /* DNREF, DNREFI */ + 0, 0 /* RECURSE, CALLOUT */ +}; + + +#ifdef DEBUG_SHOW_PARSED +/************************************************* +* Show the parsed pattern for debugging * +*************************************************/ + +/* For debugging the pre-scan, this code, which outputs the parsed data vector, +can be enabled. */ + +static void show_parsed(compile_block *cb) +{ +uint32_t *pptr = cb->parsed_pattern; + +for (;;) + { + int max, min; + PCRE2_SIZE offset; + uint32_t i; + uint32_t length; + uint32_t meta_arg = META_DATA(*pptr); + + fprintf(stderr, "+++ %02d %.8x ", (int)(pptr - cb->parsed_pattern), *pptr); + + if (*pptr < META_END) + { + if (*pptr > 32 && *pptr < 128) fprintf(stderr, "%c", *pptr); + pptr++; + } + + else switch (META_CODE(*pptr++)) + { + default: + fprintf(stderr, "**** OOPS - unknown META value - giving up ****\n"); + return; + + case META_END: + fprintf(stderr, "META_END\n"); + return; + + case META_CAPTURE: + fprintf(stderr, "META_CAPTURE %d", meta_arg); + break; + + case META_RECURSE: + GETOFFSET(offset, pptr); + fprintf(stderr, "META_RECURSE %d %zd", meta_arg, offset); + break; + + case META_BACKREF: + if (meta_arg < 10) + offset = cb->small_ref_offset[meta_arg]; + else + GETOFFSET(offset, pptr); + fprintf(stderr, "META_BACKREF %d %zd", meta_arg, offset); + break; + + case META_ESCAPE: + if (meta_arg == ESC_P || meta_arg == ESC_p) + { + uint32_t ptype = *pptr >> 16; + uint32_t pvalue = *pptr++ & 0xffff; + fprintf(stderr, "META \\%c %d %d", (meta_arg == ESC_P)? 'P':'p', + ptype, pvalue); + } + else + { + uint32_t cc; + /* There's just one escape we might have here that isn't negated in the + escapes table. */ + if (meta_arg == ESC_g) cc = CHAR_g; + else for (cc = ESCAPES_FIRST; cc <= ESCAPES_LAST; cc++) + { + if (meta_arg == (uint32_t)(-escapes[cc - ESCAPES_FIRST])) break; + } + if (cc > ESCAPES_LAST) cc = CHAR_QUESTION_MARK; + fprintf(stderr, "META \\%c", cc); + } + break; + + case META_MINMAX: + min = *pptr++; + max = *pptr++; + if (max != REPEAT_UNLIMITED) + fprintf(stderr, "META {%d,%d}", min, max); + else + fprintf(stderr, "META {%d,}", min); + break; + + case META_MINMAX_QUERY: + min = *pptr++; + max = *pptr++; + if (max != REPEAT_UNLIMITED) + fprintf(stderr, "META {%d,%d}?", min, max); + else + fprintf(stderr, "META {%d,}?", min); + break; + + case META_MINMAX_PLUS: + min = *pptr++; + max = *pptr++; + if (max != REPEAT_UNLIMITED) + fprintf(stderr, "META {%d,%d}+", min, max); + else + fprintf(stderr, "META {%d,}+", min); + break; + + case META_BIGVALUE: fprintf(stderr, "META_BIGVALUE %.8x", *pptr++); break; + case META_CIRCUMFLEX: fprintf(stderr, "META_CIRCUMFLEX"); break; + case META_COND_ASSERT: fprintf(stderr, "META_COND_ASSERT"); break; + case META_DOLLAR: fprintf(stderr, "META_DOLLAR"); break; + case META_DOT: fprintf(stderr, "META_DOT"); break; + case META_ASTERISK: fprintf(stderr, "META *"); break; + case META_ASTERISK_QUERY: fprintf(stderr, "META *?"); break; + case META_ASTERISK_PLUS: fprintf(stderr, "META *+"); break; + case META_PLUS: fprintf(stderr, "META +"); break; + case META_PLUS_QUERY: fprintf(stderr, "META +?"); break; + case META_PLUS_PLUS: fprintf(stderr, "META ++"); break; + case META_QUERY: fprintf(stderr, "META ?"); break; + case META_QUERY_QUERY: fprintf(stderr, "META ??"); break; + case META_QUERY_PLUS: fprintf(stderr, "META ?+"); break; + + case META_ATOMIC: fprintf(stderr, "META (?>"); break; + case META_NOCAPTURE: fprintf(stderr, "META (?:"); break; + case META_LOOKAHEAD: fprintf(stderr, "META (?="); break; + case META_LOOKAHEADNOT: fprintf(stderr, "META (?!"); break; + case META_LOOKAHEAD_NA: fprintf(stderr, "META (*napla:"); break; + case META_SCRIPT_RUN: fprintf(stderr, "META (*sr:"); break; + case META_KET: fprintf(stderr, "META )"); break; + case META_ALT: fprintf(stderr, "META | %d", meta_arg); break; + + case META_CLASS: fprintf(stderr, "META ["); break; + case META_CLASS_NOT: fprintf(stderr, "META [^"); break; + case META_CLASS_END: fprintf(stderr, "META ]"); break; + case META_CLASS_EMPTY: fprintf(stderr, "META []"); break; + case META_CLASS_EMPTY_NOT: fprintf(stderr, "META [^]"); break; + + case META_RANGE_LITERAL: fprintf(stderr, "META - (literal)"); break; + case META_RANGE_ESCAPED: fprintf(stderr, "META - (escaped)"); break; + + case META_POSIX: fprintf(stderr, "META_POSIX %d", *pptr++); break; + case META_POSIX_NEG: fprintf(stderr, "META_POSIX_NEG %d", *pptr++); break; + + case META_ACCEPT: fprintf(stderr, "META (*ACCEPT)"); break; + case META_FAIL: fprintf(stderr, "META (*FAIL)"); break; + case META_COMMIT: fprintf(stderr, "META (*COMMIT)"); break; + case META_PRUNE: fprintf(stderr, "META (*PRUNE)"); break; + case META_SKIP: fprintf(stderr, "META (*SKIP)"); break; + case META_THEN: fprintf(stderr, "META (*THEN)"); break; + + case META_OPTIONS: fprintf(stderr, "META_OPTIONS 0x%02x", *pptr++); break; + + case META_LOOKBEHIND: + fprintf(stderr, "META (?<= %d offset=", meta_arg); + GETOFFSET(offset, pptr); + fprintf(stderr, "%zd", offset); + break; + + case META_LOOKBEHIND_NA: + fprintf(stderr, "META (*naplb: %d offset=", meta_arg); + GETOFFSET(offset, pptr); + fprintf(stderr, "%zd", offset); + break; + + case META_LOOKBEHINDNOT: + fprintf(stderr, "META (?<! %d offset=", meta_arg); + GETOFFSET(offset, pptr); + fprintf(stderr, "%zd", offset); + break; + + case META_CALLOUT_NUMBER: + fprintf(stderr, "META (?C%d) next=%d/%d", pptr[2], pptr[0], + pptr[1]); + pptr += 3; + break; + + case META_CALLOUT_STRING: + { + uint32_t patoffset = *pptr++; /* Offset of next pattern item */ + uint32_t patlength = *pptr++; /* Length of next pattern item */ + fprintf(stderr, "META (?Cstring) length=%d offset=", *pptr++); + GETOFFSET(offset, pptr); + fprintf(stderr, "%zd next=%d/%d", offset, patoffset, patlength); + } + break; + + case META_RECURSE_BYNAME: + fprintf(stderr, "META (?(&name) length=%d offset=", *pptr++); + GETOFFSET(offset, pptr); + fprintf(stderr, "%zd", offset); + break; + + case META_BACKREF_BYNAME: + fprintf(stderr, "META_BACKREF_BYNAME length=%d offset=", *pptr++); + GETOFFSET(offset, pptr); + fprintf(stderr, "%zd", offset); + break; + + case META_COND_NUMBER: + fprintf(stderr, "META_COND_NUMBER %d offset=", pptr[SIZEOFFSET]); + GETOFFSET(offset, pptr); + fprintf(stderr, "%zd", offset); + pptr++; + break; + + case META_COND_DEFINE: + fprintf(stderr, "META (?(DEFINE) offset="); + GETOFFSET(offset, pptr); + fprintf(stderr, "%zd", offset); + break; + + case META_COND_VERSION: + fprintf(stderr, "META (?(VERSION%s", (*pptr++ == 0)? "=" : ">="); + fprintf(stderr, "%d.", *pptr++); + fprintf(stderr, "%d)", *pptr++); + break; + + case META_COND_NAME: + fprintf(stderr, "META (?(<name>) length=%d offset=", *pptr++); + GETOFFSET(offset, pptr); + fprintf(stderr, "%zd", offset); + break; + + case META_COND_RNAME: + fprintf(stderr, "META (?(R&name) length=%d offset=", *pptr++); + GETOFFSET(offset, pptr); + fprintf(stderr, "%zd", offset); + break; + + /* This is kept as a name, because it might be. */ + + case META_COND_RNUMBER: + fprintf(stderr, "META (?(Rnumber) length=%d offset=", *pptr++); + GETOFFSET(offset, pptr); + fprintf(stderr, "%zd", offset); + break; + + case META_MARK: + fprintf(stderr, "META (*MARK:"); + goto SHOWARG; + + case META_COMMIT_ARG: + fprintf(stderr, "META (*COMMIT:"); + goto SHOWARG; + + case META_PRUNE_ARG: + fprintf(stderr, "META (*PRUNE:"); + goto SHOWARG; + + case META_SKIP_ARG: + fprintf(stderr, "META (*SKIP:"); + goto SHOWARG; + + case META_THEN_ARG: + fprintf(stderr, "META (*THEN:"); + SHOWARG: + length = *pptr++; + for (i = 0; i < length; i++) + { + uint32_t cc = *pptr++; + if (cc > 32 && cc < 128) fprintf(stderr, "%c", cc); + else fprintf(stderr, "\\x{%x}", cc); + } + fprintf(stderr, ") length=%u", length); + break; + } + fprintf(stderr, "\n"); + } +return; +} +#endif /* DEBUG_SHOW_PARSED */ + + + +/************************************************* +* Copy compiled code * +*************************************************/ + +/* Compiled JIT code cannot be copied, so the new compiled block has no +associated JIT data. */ + +PCRE2_EXP_DEFN pcre2_code * PCRE2_CALL_CONVENTION +pcre2_code_copy(const pcre2_code *code) +{ +PCRE2_SIZE* ref_count; +pcre2_code *newcode; + +if (code == NULL) return NULL; +newcode = code->memctl.malloc(code->blocksize, code->memctl.memory_data); +if (newcode == NULL) return NULL; +memcpy(newcode, code, code->blocksize); +newcode->executable_jit = NULL; + +/* If the code is one that has been deserialized, increment the reference count +in the decoded tables. */ + +if ((code->flags & PCRE2_DEREF_TABLES) != 0) + { + ref_count = (PCRE2_SIZE *)(code->tables + TABLES_LENGTH); + (*ref_count)++; + } + +return newcode; +} + + + +/************************************************* +* Copy compiled code and character tables * +*************************************************/ + +/* Compiled JIT code cannot be copied, so the new compiled block has no +associated JIT data. This version of code_copy also makes a separate copy of +the character tables. */ + +PCRE2_EXP_DEFN pcre2_code * PCRE2_CALL_CONVENTION +pcre2_code_copy_with_tables(const pcre2_code *code) +{ +PCRE2_SIZE* ref_count; +pcre2_code *newcode; +uint8_t *newtables; + +if (code == NULL) return NULL; +newcode = code->memctl.malloc(code->blocksize, code->memctl.memory_data); +if (newcode == NULL) return NULL; +memcpy(newcode, code, code->blocksize); +newcode->executable_jit = NULL; + +newtables = code->memctl.malloc(TABLES_LENGTH + sizeof(PCRE2_SIZE), + code->memctl.memory_data); +if (newtables == NULL) + { + code->memctl.free((void *)newcode, code->memctl.memory_data); + return NULL; + } +memcpy(newtables, code->tables, TABLES_LENGTH); +ref_count = (PCRE2_SIZE *)(newtables + TABLES_LENGTH); +*ref_count = 1; + +newcode->tables = newtables; +newcode->flags |= PCRE2_DEREF_TABLES; +return newcode; +} + + + +/************************************************* +* Free compiled code * +*************************************************/ + +PCRE2_EXP_DEFN void PCRE2_CALL_CONVENTION +pcre2_code_free(pcre2_code *code) +{ +PCRE2_SIZE* ref_count; + +if (code != NULL) + { +#ifdef SUPPORT_JIT + if (code->executable_jit != NULL) + PRIV(jit_free)(code->executable_jit, &code->memctl); +#endif + + if ((code->flags & PCRE2_DEREF_TABLES) != 0) + { + /* Decoded tables belong to the codes after deserialization, and they must + be freed when there are no more references to them. The *ref_count should + always be > 0. */ + + ref_count = (PCRE2_SIZE *)(code->tables + TABLES_LENGTH); + if (*ref_count > 0) + { + (*ref_count)--; + if (*ref_count == 0) + code->memctl.free((void *)code->tables, code->memctl.memory_data); + } + } + + code->memctl.free(code, code->memctl.memory_data); + } +} + + + +/************************************************* +* Read a number, possibly signed * +*************************************************/ + +/* This function is used to read numbers in the pattern. The initial pointer +must be the sign or first digit of the number. When relative values (introduced +by + or -) are allowed, they are relative group numbers, and the result must be +greater than zero. + +Arguments: + ptrptr points to the character pointer variable + ptrend points to the end of the input string + allow_sign if < 0, sign not allowed; if >= 0, sign is relative to this + max_value the largest number allowed + max_error the error to give for an over-large number + intptr where to put the result + errcodeptr where to put an error code + +Returns: TRUE - a number was read + FALSE - errorcode == 0 => no number was found + errorcode != 0 => an error occurred +*/ + +static BOOL +read_number(PCRE2_SPTR *ptrptr, PCRE2_SPTR ptrend, int32_t allow_sign, + uint32_t max_value, uint32_t max_error, int *intptr, int *errorcodeptr) +{ +int sign = 0; +uint32_t n = 0; +PCRE2_SPTR ptr = *ptrptr; +BOOL yield = FALSE; + +*errorcodeptr = 0; + +if (allow_sign >= 0 && ptr < ptrend) + { + if (*ptr == CHAR_PLUS) + { + sign = +1; + max_value -= allow_sign; + ptr++; + } + else if (*ptr == CHAR_MINUS) + { + sign = -1; + ptr++; + } + } + +if (ptr >= ptrend || !IS_DIGIT(*ptr)) return FALSE; +while (ptr < ptrend && IS_DIGIT(*ptr)) + { + n = n * 10 + *ptr++ - CHAR_0; + if (n > max_value) + { + *errorcodeptr = max_error; + goto EXIT; + } + } + +if (allow_sign >= 0 && sign != 0) + { + if (n == 0) + { + *errorcodeptr = ERR26; /* +0 and -0 are not allowed */ + goto EXIT; + } + + if (sign > 0) n += allow_sign; + else if ((int)n > allow_sign) + { + *errorcodeptr = ERR15; /* Non-existent subpattern */ + goto EXIT; + } + else n = allow_sign + 1 - n; + } + +yield = TRUE; + +EXIT: +*intptr = n; +*ptrptr = ptr; +return yield; +} + + + +/************************************************* +* Read repeat counts * +*************************************************/ + +/* Read an item of the form {n,m} and return the values if non-NULL pointers +are supplied. Repeat counts must be less than 65536 (MAX_REPEAT_COUNT); a +larger value is used for "unlimited". We have to use signed arguments for +read_number() because it is capable of returning a signed value. + +Arguments: + ptrptr points to pointer to character after'{' + ptrend pointer to end of input + minp if not NULL, pointer to int for min + maxp if not NULL, pointer to int for max (-1 if no max) + returned as -1 if no max + errorcodeptr points to error code variable + +Returns: FALSE if not a repeat quantifier, errorcode set zero + FALSE on error, with errorcode set non-zero + TRUE on success, with pointer updated to point after '}' +*/ + +static BOOL +read_repeat_counts(PCRE2_SPTR *ptrptr, PCRE2_SPTR ptrend, uint32_t *minp, + uint32_t *maxp, int *errorcodeptr) +{ +PCRE2_SPTR p; +BOOL yield = FALSE; +BOOL had_comma = FALSE; +int32_t min = 0; +int32_t max = REPEAT_UNLIMITED; /* This value is larger than MAX_REPEAT_COUNT */ + +/* Check the syntax */ + +*errorcodeptr = 0; +for (p = *ptrptr;; p++) + { + uint32_t c; + if (p >= ptrend) return FALSE; + c = *p; + if (IS_DIGIT(c)) continue; + if (c == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET) break; + if (c == CHAR_COMMA) + { + if (had_comma) return FALSE; + had_comma = TRUE; + } + else return FALSE; + } + +/* The only error from read_number() is for a number that is too big. */ + +p = *ptrptr; +if (!read_number(&p, ptrend, -1, MAX_REPEAT_COUNT, ERR5, &min, errorcodeptr)) + goto EXIT; + +if (*p == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET) + { + p++; + max = min; + } +else + { + if (*(++p) != CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET) + { + if (!read_number(&p, ptrend, -1, MAX_REPEAT_COUNT, ERR5, &max, + errorcodeptr)) + goto EXIT; + if (max < min) + { + *errorcodeptr = ERR4; + goto EXIT; + } + } + p++; + } + +yield = TRUE; +if (minp != NULL) *minp = (uint32_t)min; +if (maxp != NULL) *maxp = (uint32_t)max; + +/* Update the pattern pointer */ + +EXIT: +*ptrptr = p; +return yield; +} + + + +/************************************************* +* Handle escapes * +*************************************************/ + +/* This function is called when a \ has been encountered. It either returns a +positive value for a simple escape such as \d, or 0 for a data character, which +is placed in chptr. A backreference to group n is returned as negative n. On +entry, ptr is pointing at the character after \. On exit, it points after the +final code unit of the escape sequence. + +This function is also called from pcre2_substitute() to handle escape sequences +in replacement strings. In this case, the cb argument is NULL, and in the case +of escapes that have further processing, only sequences that define a data +character are recognised. The isclass argument is not relevant; the options +argument is the final value of the compiled pattern's options. + +Arguments: + ptrptr points to the input position pointer + ptrend points to the end of the input + chptr points to a returned data character + errorcodeptr points to the errorcode variable (containing zero) + options the current options bits + isclass TRUE if inside a character class + cb compile data block or NULL when called from pcre2_substitute() + +Returns: zero => a data character + positive => a special escape sequence + negative => a numerical back reference + on error, errorcodeptr is set non-zero +*/ + +int +PRIV(check_escape)(PCRE2_SPTR *ptrptr, PCRE2_SPTR ptrend, uint32_t *chptr, + int *errorcodeptr, uint32_t options, uint32_t extra_options, BOOL isclass, + compile_block *cb) +{ +BOOL utf = (options & PCRE2_UTF) != 0; +PCRE2_SPTR ptr = *ptrptr; +uint32_t c, cc; +int escape = 0; +int i; + +/* If backslash is at the end of the string, it's an error. */ + +if (ptr >= ptrend) + { + *errorcodeptr = ERR1; + return 0; + } + +GETCHARINCTEST(c, ptr); /* Get character value, increment pointer */ +*errorcodeptr = 0; /* Be optimistic */ + +/* Non-alphanumerics are literals, so we just leave the value in c. An initial +value test saves a memory lookup for code points outside the alphanumeric +range. */ + +if (c < ESCAPES_FIRST || c > ESCAPES_LAST) {} /* Definitely literal */ + +/* Otherwise, do a table lookup. Non-zero values need little processing here. A +positive value is a literal value for something like \n. A negative value is +the negation of one of the ESC_ macros that is passed back for handling by the +calling function. Some extra checking is needed for \N because only \N{U+dddd} +is supported. If the value is zero, further processing is handled below. */ + +else if ((i = escapes[c - ESCAPES_FIRST]) != 0) + { + if (i > 0) + { + c = (uint32_t)i; + if (c == CHAR_CR && (extra_options & PCRE2_EXTRA_ESCAPED_CR_IS_LF) != 0) + c = CHAR_LF; + } + else /* Negative table entry */ + { + escape = -i; /* Else return a special escape */ + if (cb != NULL && (escape == ESC_P || escape == ESC_p || escape == ESC_X)) + cb->external_flags |= PCRE2_HASBKPORX; /* Note \P, \p, or \X */ + + /* Perl supports \N{name} for character names and \N{U+dddd} for numerical + Unicode code points, as well as plain \N for "not newline". PCRE does not + support \N{name}. However, it does support quantification such as \N{2,3}, + so if \N{ is not followed by U+dddd we check for a quantifier. */ + + if (escape == ESC_N && ptr < ptrend && *ptr == CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET) + { + PCRE2_SPTR p = ptr + 1; + + /* \N{U+ can be handled by the \x{ code. However, this construction is + not valid in EBCDIC environments because it specifies a Unicode + character, not a codepoint in the local code. For example \N{U+0041} + must be "A" in all environments. Also, in Perl, \N{U+ forces Unicode + casing semantics for the entire pattern, so allow it only in UTF (i.e. + Unicode) mode. */ + + if (ptrend - p > 1 && *p == CHAR_U && p[1] == CHAR_PLUS) + { +#ifdef EBCDIC + *errorcodeptr = ERR93; +#else + if (utf) + { + ptr = p + 1; + escape = 0; /* Not a fancy escape after all */ + goto COME_FROM_NU; + } + else *errorcodeptr = ERR93; +#endif + } + + /* Give an error if what follows is not a quantifier, but don't override + an error set by the quantifier reader (e.g. number overflow). */ + + else + { + if (!read_repeat_counts(&p, ptrend, NULL, NULL, errorcodeptr) && + *errorcodeptr == 0) + *errorcodeptr = ERR37; + } + } + } + } + +/* Escapes that need further processing, including those that are unknown, have +a zero entry in the lookup table. When called from pcre2_substitute(), only \c, +\o, and \x are recognized (\u and \U can never appear as they are used for case +forcing). */ + +else + { + int s; + PCRE2_SPTR oldptr; + BOOL overflow; + BOOL alt_bsux = + ((options & PCRE2_ALT_BSUX) | (extra_options & PCRE2_EXTRA_ALT_BSUX)) != 0; + + /* Filter calls from pcre2_substitute(). */ + + if (cb == NULL) + { + if (c != CHAR_c && c != CHAR_o && c != CHAR_x) + { + *errorcodeptr = ERR3; + return 0; + } + alt_bsux = FALSE; /* Do not modify \x handling */ + } + + switch (c) + { + /* A number of Perl escapes are not handled by PCRE. We give an explicit + error. */ + + case CHAR_F: + case CHAR_l: + case CHAR_L: + *errorcodeptr = ERR37; + break; + + /* \u is unrecognized when neither PCRE2_ALT_BSUX nor PCRE2_EXTRA_ALT_BSUX + is set. Otherwise, \u must be followed by exactly four hex digits or, if + PCRE2_EXTRA_ALT_BSUX is set, by any number of hex digits in braces. + Otherwise it is a lowercase u letter. This gives some compatibility with + ECMAScript (aka JavaScript). */ + + case CHAR_u: + if (!alt_bsux) *errorcodeptr = ERR37; else + { + uint32_t xc; + + if (ptr >= ptrend) break; + if (*ptr == CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET && + (extra_options & PCRE2_EXTRA_ALT_BSUX) != 0) + { + PCRE2_SPTR hptr = ptr + 1; + cc = 0; + + while (hptr < ptrend && (xc = XDIGIT(*hptr)) != 0xff) + { + if ((cc & 0xf0000000) != 0) /* Test for 32-bit overflow */ + { + *errorcodeptr = ERR77; + ptr = hptr; /* Show where */ + break; /* *hptr != } will cause another break below */ + } + cc = (cc << 4) | xc; + hptr++; + } + + if (hptr == ptr + 1 || /* No hex digits */ + hptr >= ptrend || /* Hit end of input */ + *hptr != CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET) /* No } terminator */ + break; /* Hex escape not recognized */ + + c = cc; /* Accept the code point */ + ptr = hptr + 1; + } + + else /* Must be exactly 4 hex digits */ + { + if (ptrend - ptr < 4) break; /* Less than 4 chars */ + if ((cc = XDIGIT(ptr[0])) == 0xff) break; /* Not a hex digit */ + if ((xc = XDIGIT(ptr[1])) == 0xff) break; /* Not a hex digit */ + cc = (cc << 4) | xc; + if ((xc = XDIGIT(ptr[2])) == 0xff) break; /* Not a hex digit */ + cc = (cc << 4) | xc; + if ((xc = XDIGIT(ptr[3])) == 0xff) break; /* Not a hex digit */ + c = (cc << 4) | xc; + ptr += 4; + } + + if (utf) + { + if (c > 0x10ffffU) *errorcodeptr = ERR77; + else + if (c >= 0xd800 && c <= 0xdfff && + (extra_options & PCRE2_EXTRA_ALLOW_SURROGATE_ESCAPES) == 0) + *errorcodeptr = ERR73; + } + else if (c > MAX_NON_UTF_CHAR) *errorcodeptr = ERR77; + } + break; + + /* \U is unrecognized unless PCRE2_ALT_BSUX or PCRE2_EXTRA_ALT_BSUX is set, + in which case it is an upper case letter. */ + + case CHAR_U: + if (!alt_bsux) *errorcodeptr = ERR37; + break; + + /* In a character class, \g is just a literal "g". Outside a character + class, \g must be followed by one of a number of specific things: + + (1) A number, either plain or braced. If positive, it is an absolute + backreference. If negative, it is a relative backreference. This is a Perl + 5.10 feature. + + (2) Perl 5.10 also supports \g{name} as a reference to a named group. This + is part of Perl's movement towards a unified syntax for back references. As + this is synonymous with \k{name}, we fudge it up by pretending it really + was \k{name}. + + (3) For Oniguruma compatibility we also support \g followed by a name or a + number either in angle brackets or in single quotes. However, these are + (possibly recursive) subroutine calls, _not_ backreferences. We return + the ESC_g code. + + Summary: Return a negative number for a numerical back reference, ESC_k for + a named back reference, and ESC_g for a named or numbered subroutine call. + */ + + case CHAR_g: + if (isclass) break; + + if (ptr >= ptrend) + { + *errorcodeptr = ERR57; + break; + } + + if (*ptr == CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN || *ptr == CHAR_APOSTROPHE) + { + escape = ESC_g; + break; + } + + /* If there is a brace delimiter, try to read a numerical reference. If + there isn't one, assume we have a name and treat it as \k. */ + + if (*ptr == CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET) + { + PCRE2_SPTR p = ptr + 1; + if (!read_number(&p, ptrend, cb->bracount, MAX_GROUP_NUMBER, ERR61, &s, + errorcodeptr)) + { + if (*errorcodeptr == 0) escape = ESC_k; /* No number found */ + break; + } + if (p >= ptrend || *p != CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET) + { + *errorcodeptr = ERR57; + break; + } + ptr = p + 1; + } + + /* Read an undelimited number */ + + else + { + if (!read_number(&ptr, ptrend, cb->bracount, MAX_GROUP_NUMBER, ERR61, &s, + errorcodeptr)) + { + if (*errorcodeptr == 0) *errorcodeptr = ERR57; /* No number found */ + break; + } + } + + if (s <= 0) + { + *errorcodeptr = ERR15; + break; + } + + escape = -s; + break; + + /* The handling of escape sequences consisting of a string of digits + starting with one that is not zero is not straightforward. Perl has changed + over the years. Nowadays \g{} for backreferences and \o{} for octal are + recommended to avoid the ambiguities in the old syntax. + + Outside a character class, the digits are read as a decimal number. If the + number is less than 10, or if there are that many previous extracting left + brackets, it is a back reference. Otherwise, up to three octal digits are + read to form an escaped character code. Thus \123 is likely to be octal 123 + (cf \0123, which is octal 012 followed by the literal 3). + + Inside a character class, \ followed by a digit is always either a literal + 8 or 9 or an octal number. */ + + case CHAR_1: case CHAR_2: case CHAR_3: case CHAR_4: case CHAR_5: + case CHAR_6: case CHAR_7: case CHAR_8: case CHAR_9: + + if (!isclass) + { + oldptr = ptr; + ptr--; /* Back to the digit */ + + /* As we know we are at a digit, the only possible error from + read_number() is a number that is too large to be a group number. In this + case we fall through handle this as not a group reference. If we have + read a small enough number, check for a back reference. + + \1 to \9 are always back references. \8x and \9x are too; \1x to \7x + are octal escapes if there are not that many previous captures. */ + + if (read_number(&ptr, ptrend, -1, INT_MAX/10 - 1, 0, &s, errorcodeptr) && + (s < 10 || oldptr[-1] >= CHAR_8 || s <= (int)cb->bracount)) + { + if (s > (int)MAX_GROUP_NUMBER) *errorcodeptr = ERR61; + else escape = -s; /* Indicates a back reference */ + break; + } + + ptr = oldptr; /* Put the pointer back and fall through */ + } + + /* Handle a digit following \ when the number is not a back reference, or + we are within a character class. If the first digit is 8 or 9, Perl used to + generate a binary zero and then treat the digit as a following literal. At + least by Perl 5.18 this changed so as not to insert the binary zero. */ + + if (c >= CHAR_8) break; + + /* Fall through */ + + /* \0 always starts an octal number, but we may drop through to here with a + larger first octal digit. The original code used just to take the least + significant 8 bits of octal numbers (I think this is what early Perls used + to do). Nowadays we allow for larger numbers in UTF-8 mode and 16-bit mode, + but no more than 3 octal digits. */ + + case CHAR_0: + c -= CHAR_0; + while(i++ < 2 && ptr < ptrend && *ptr >= CHAR_0 && *ptr <= CHAR_7) + c = c * 8 + *ptr++ - CHAR_0; +#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 8 + if (!utf && c > 0xff) *errorcodeptr = ERR51; +#endif + break; + + /* \o is a relatively new Perl feature, supporting a more general way of + specifying character codes in octal. The only supported form is \o{ddd}. */ + + case CHAR_o: + if (ptr >= ptrend || *ptr++ != CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET) + { + ptr--; + *errorcodeptr = ERR55; + } + else if (ptr >= ptrend || *ptr == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET) + *errorcodeptr = ERR78; + else + { + c = 0; + overflow = FALSE; + while (ptr < ptrend && *ptr >= CHAR_0 && *ptr <= CHAR_7) + { + cc = *ptr++; + if (c == 0 && cc == CHAR_0) continue; /* Leading zeroes */ +#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 32 + if (c >= 0x20000000l) { overflow = TRUE; break; } +#endif + c = (c << 3) + (cc - CHAR_0); +#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 8 + if (c > (utf ? 0x10ffffU : 0xffU)) { overflow = TRUE; break; } +#elif PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 16 + if (c > (utf ? 0x10ffffU : 0xffffU)) { overflow = TRUE; break; } +#elif PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 32 + if (utf && c > 0x10ffffU) { overflow = TRUE; break; } +#endif + } + if (overflow) + { + while (ptr < ptrend && *ptr >= CHAR_0 && *ptr <= CHAR_7) ptr++; + *errorcodeptr = ERR34; + } + else if (ptr < ptrend && *ptr++ == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET) + { + if (utf && c >= 0xd800 && c <= 0xdfff && + (extra_options & PCRE2_EXTRA_ALLOW_SURROGATE_ESCAPES) == 0) + { + ptr--; + *errorcodeptr = ERR73; + } + } + else + { + ptr--; + *errorcodeptr = ERR64; + } + } + break; + + /* When PCRE2_ALT_BSUX or PCRE2_EXTRA_ALT_BSUX is set, \x must be followed + by two hexadecimal digits. Otherwise it is a lowercase x letter. */ + + case CHAR_x: + if (alt_bsux) + { + uint32_t xc; + if (ptrend - ptr < 2) break; /* Less than 2 characters */ + if ((cc = XDIGIT(ptr[0])) == 0xff) break; /* Not a hex digit */ + if ((xc = XDIGIT(ptr[1])) == 0xff) break; /* Not a hex digit */ + c = (cc << 4) | xc; + ptr += 2; + } + + /* Handle \x in Perl's style. \x{ddd} is a character code which can be + greater than 0xff in UTF-8 or non-8bit mode, but only if the ddd are hex + digits. If not, { used to be treated as a data character. However, Perl + seems to read hex digits up to the first non-such, and ignore the rest, so + that, for example \x{zz} matches a binary zero. This seems crazy, so PCRE + now gives an error. */ + + else + { + if (ptr < ptrend && *ptr == CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET) + { +#ifndef EBCDIC + COME_FROM_NU: +#endif + if (++ptr >= ptrend || *ptr == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET) + { + *errorcodeptr = ERR78; + break; + } + c = 0; + overflow = FALSE; + + while (ptr < ptrend && (cc = XDIGIT(*ptr)) != 0xff) + { + ptr++; + if (c == 0 && cc == 0) continue; /* Leading zeroes */ +#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 32 + if (c >= 0x10000000l) { overflow = TRUE; break; } +#endif + c = (c << 4) | cc; + if ((utf && c > 0x10ffffU) || (!utf && c > MAX_NON_UTF_CHAR)) + { + overflow = TRUE; + break; + } + } + + if (overflow) + { + while (ptr < ptrend && XDIGIT(*ptr) != 0xff) ptr++; + *errorcodeptr = ERR34; + } + else if (ptr < ptrend && *ptr++ == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET) + { + if (utf && c >= 0xd800 && c <= 0xdfff && + (extra_options & PCRE2_EXTRA_ALLOW_SURROGATE_ESCAPES) == 0) + { + ptr--; + *errorcodeptr = ERR73; + } + } + + /* If the sequence of hex digits does not end with '}', give an error. + We used just to recognize this construct and fall through to the normal + \x handling, but nowadays Perl gives an error, which seems much more + sensible, so we do too. */ + + else + { + ptr--; + *errorcodeptr = ERR67; + } + } /* End of \x{} processing */ + + /* Read a up to two hex digits after \x */ + + else + { + c = 0; + if (ptr >= ptrend || (cc = XDIGIT(*ptr)) == 0xff) break; /* Not a hex digit */ + ptr++; + c = cc; + if (ptr >= ptrend || (cc = XDIGIT(*ptr)) == 0xff) break; /* Not a hex digit */ + ptr++; + c = (c << 4) | cc; + } /* End of \xdd handling */ + } /* End of Perl-style \x handling */ + break; + + /* The handling of \c is different in ASCII and EBCDIC environments. In an + ASCII (or Unicode) environment, an error is given if the character + following \c is not a printable ASCII character. Otherwise, the following + character is upper-cased if it is a letter, and after that the 0x40 bit is + flipped. The result is the value of the escape. + + In an EBCDIC environment the handling of \c is compatible with the + specification in the perlebcdic document. The following character must be + a letter or one of small number of special characters. These provide a + means of defining the character values 0-31. + + For testing the EBCDIC handling of \c in an ASCII environment, recognize + the EBCDIC value of 'c' explicitly. */ + +#if defined EBCDIC && 'a' != 0x81 + case 0x83: +#else + case CHAR_c: +#endif + if (ptr >= ptrend) + { + *errorcodeptr = ERR2; + break; + } + c = *ptr; + if (c >= CHAR_a && c <= CHAR_z) c = UPPER_CASE(c); + + /* Handle \c in an ASCII/Unicode environment. */ + +#ifndef EBCDIC /* ASCII/UTF-8 coding */ + if (c < 32 || c > 126) /* Excludes all non-printable ASCII */ + { + *errorcodeptr = ERR68; + break; + } + c ^= 0x40; + + /* Handle \c in an EBCDIC environment. The special case \c? is converted to + 255 (0xff) or 95 (0x5f) if other characters suggest we are using the + POSIX-BC encoding. (This is the way Perl indicates that it handles \c?.) + The other valid sequences correspond to a list of specific characters. */ + +#else + if (c == CHAR_QUESTION_MARK) + c = ('\\' == 188 && '`' == 74)? 0x5f : 0xff; + else + { + for (i = 0; i < 32; i++) + { + if (c == ebcdic_escape_c[i]) break; + } + if (i < 32) c = i; else *errorcodeptr = ERR68; + } +#endif /* EBCDIC */ + + ptr++; + break; + + /* Any other alphanumeric following \ is an error. Perl gives an error only + if in warning mode, but PCRE doesn't have a warning mode. */ + + default: + *errorcodeptr = ERR3; + *ptrptr = ptr - 1; /* Point to the character at fault */ + return 0; + } + } + +/* Set the pointer to the next character before returning. */ + +*ptrptr = ptr; +*chptr = c; +return escape; +} + + + +#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE +/************************************************* +* Handle \P and \p * +*************************************************/ + +/* This function is called after \P or \p has been encountered, provided that +PCRE2 is compiled with support for UTF and Unicode properties. On entry, the +contents of ptrptr are pointing after the P or p. On exit, it is left pointing +after the final code unit of the escape sequence. + +Arguments: + ptrptr the pattern position pointer + negptr a boolean that is set TRUE for negation else FALSE + ptypeptr an unsigned int that is set to the type value + pdataptr an unsigned int that is set to the detailed property value + errorcodeptr the error code variable + cb the compile data + +Returns: TRUE if the type value was found, or FALSE for an invalid type +*/ + +static BOOL +get_ucp(PCRE2_SPTR *ptrptr, BOOL *negptr, uint16_t *ptypeptr, + uint16_t *pdataptr, int *errorcodeptr, compile_block *cb) +{ +PCRE2_UCHAR c; +PCRE2_SIZE i, bot, top; +PCRE2_SPTR ptr = *ptrptr; +PCRE2_UCHAR name[50]; +PCRE2_UCHAR *vptr = NULL; +uint16_t ptscript = PT_NOTSCRIPT; + +if (ptr >= cb->end_pattern) goto ERROR_RETURN; +c = *ptr++; +*negptr = FALSE; + +/* \P or \p can be followed by a name in {}, optionally preceded by ^ for +negation. */ + +if (c == CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET) + { + if (ptr >= cb->end_pattern) goto ERROR_RETURN; + + if (*ptr == CHAR_CIRCUMFLEX_ACCENT) + { + *negptr = TRUE; + ptr++; + } + + for (i = 0; i < (int)(sizeof(name) / sizeof(PCRE2_UCHAR)) - 1; i++) + { + if (ptr >= cb->end_pattern) goto ERROR_RETURN; + c = *ptr++; + while (c == '_' || c == '-' || isspace(c)) + { + if (ptr >= cb->end_pattern) goto ERROR_RETURN; + c = *ptr++; + } + if (c == CHAR_NUL) goto ERROR_RETURN; + if (c == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET) break; + name[i] = tolower(c); + if ((c == ':' || c == '=') && vptr == NULL) vptr = name + i; + } + + if (c != CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET) goto ERROR_RETURN; + name[i] = 0; + } + +/* If { doesn't follow \p or \P there is just one following character, which +must be an ASCII letter. */ + +else if (MAX_255(c) && (cb->ctypes[c] & ctype_letter) != 0) + { + name[0] = tolower(c); + name[1] = 0; + } +else goto ERROR_RETURN; + +*ptrptr = ptr; + +/* If the property contains ':' or '=' we have class name and value separately +specified. The following are supported: + + . Bidi_Class (synonym bc), for which the property names are "bidi<name>". + . Script (synonym sc) for which the property name is the script name + . Script_Extensions (synonym scx), ditto + +As this is a small number, we currently just check the names directly. If this +grows, a sorted table and a switch will be neater. + +For both the script properties, set a PT_xxx value so that (1) they can be +distinguished and (2) invalid script names that happen to be the name of +another property can be diagnosed. */ + +if (vptr != NULL) + { + int offset = 0; + PCRE2_UCHAR sname[8]; + + *vptr = 0; /* Terminate property name */ + if (PRIV(strcmp_c8)(name, STRING_bidiclass) == 0 || + PRIV(strcmp_c8)(name, STRING_bc) == 0) + { + offset = 4; + sname[0] = CHAR_b; + sname[1] = CHAR_i; /* There is no strcpy_c8 function */ + sname[2] = CHAR_d; + sname[3] = CHAR_i; + } + + else if (PRIV(strcmp_c8)(name, STRING_script) == 0 || + PRIV(strcmp_c8)(name, STRING_sc) == 0) + ptscript = PT_SC; + + else if (PRIV(strcmp_c8)(name, STRING_scriptextensions) == 0 || + PRIV(strcmp_c8)(name, STRING_scx) == 0) + ptscript = PT_SCX; + + else + { + *errorcodeptr = ERR47; + return FALSE; + } + + /* Adjust the string in name[] as needed */ + + memmove(name + offset, vptr + 1, (name + i - vptr)*sizeof(PCRE2_UCHAR)); + if (offset != 0) memmove(name, sname, offset*sizeof(PCRE2_UCHAR)); + } + +/* Search for a recognized property using binary chop. */ + +bot = 0; +top = PRIV(utt_size); + +while (bot < top) + { + int r; + i = (bot + top) >> 1; + r = PRIV(strcmp_c8)(name, PRIV(utt_names) + PRIV(utt)[i].name_offset); + + /* When a matching property is found, some extra checking is needed when the + \p{xx:yy} syntax is used and xx is either sc or scx. */ + + if (r == 0) + { + *pdataptr = PRIV(utt)[i].value; + if (vptr == NULL || ptscript == PT_NOTSCRIPT) + { + *ptypeptr = PRIV(utt)[i].type; + return TRUE; + } + + switch (PRIV(utt)[i].type) + { + case PT_SC: + *ptypeptr = PT_SC; + return TRUE; + + case PT_SCX: + *ptypeptr = ptscript; + return TRUE; + } + + break; /* Non-script found */ + } + + if (r > 0) bot = i + 1; else top = i; + } + +*errorcodeptr = ERR47; /* Unrecognized property */ +return FALSE; + +ERROR_RETURN: /* Malformed \P or \p */ +*errorcodeptr = ERR46; +*ptrptr = ptr; +return FALSE; +} +#endif + + + +/************************************************* +* Check for POSIX class syntax * +*************************************************/ + +/* This function is called when the sequence "[:" or "[." or "[=" is +encountered in a character class. It checks whether this is followed by a +sequence of characters terminated by a matching ":]" or ".]" or "=]". If we +reach an unescaped ']' without the special preceding character, return FALSE. + +Originally, this function only recognized a sequence of letters between the +terminators, but it seems that Perl recognizes any sequence of characters, +though of course unknown POSIX names are subsequently rejected. Perl gives an +"Unknown POSIX class" error for [:f\oo:] for example, where previously PCRE +didn't consider this to be a POSIX class. Likewise for [:1234:]. + +The problem in trying to be exactly like Perl is in the handling of escapes. We +have to be sure that [abc[:x\]pqr] is *not* treated as containing a POSIX +class, but [abc[:x\]pqr:]] is (so that an error can be generated). The code +below handles the special cases \\ and \], but does not try to do any other +escape processing. This makes it different from Perl for cases such as +[:l\ower:] where Perl recognizes it as the POSIX class "lower" but PCRE does +not recognize "l\ower". This is a lesser evil than not diagnosing bad classes +when Perl does, I think. + +A user pointed out that PCRE was rejecting [:a[:digit:]] whereas Perl was not. +It seems that the appearance of a nested POSIX class supersedes an apparent +external class. For example, [:a[:digit:]b:] matches "a", "b", ":", or +a digit. This is handled by returning FALSE if the start of a new group with +the same terminator is encountered, since the next closing sequence must close +the nested group, not the outer one. + +In Perl, unescaped square brackets may also appear as part of class names. For +example, [:a[:abc]b:] gives unknown POSIX class "[:abc]b:]". However, for +[:a[:abc]b][b:] it gives unknown POSIX class "[:abc]b][b:]", which does not +seem right at all. PCRE does not allow closing square brackets in POSIX class +names. + +Arguments: + ptr pointer to the character after the initial [ (colon, dot, equals) + ptrend pointer to the end of the pattern + endptr where to return a pointer to the terminating ':', '.', or '=' + +Returns: TRUE or FALSE +*/ + +static BOOL +check_posix_syntax(PCRE2_SPTR ptr, PCRE2_SPTR ptrend, PCRE2_SPTR *endptr) +{ +PCRE2_UCHAR terminator; /* Don't combine these lines; the Solaris cc */ +terminator = *ptr++; /* compiler warns about "non-constant" initializer. */ + +for (; ptrend - ptr >= 2; ptr++) + { + if (*ptr == CHAR_BACKSLASH && + (ptr[1] == CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET || ptr[1] == CHAR_BACKSLASH)) + ptr++; + + else if ((*ptr == CHAR_LEFT_SQUARE_BRACKET && ptr[1] == terminator) || + *ptr == CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET) return FALSE; + + else if (*ptr == terminator && ptr[1] == CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET) + { + *endptr = ptr; + return TRUE; + } + } + +return FALSE; +} + + + +/************************************************* +* Check POSIX class name * +*************************************************/ + +/* This function is called to check the name given in a POSIX-style class entry +such as [:alnum:]. + +Arguments: + ptr points to the first letter + len the length of the name + +Returns: a value representing the name, or -1 if unknown +*/ + +static int +check_posix_name(PCRE2_SPTR ptr, int len) +{ +const char *pn = posix_names; +int yield = 0; +while (posix_name_lengths[yield] != 0) + { + if (len == posix_name_lengths[yield] && + PRIV(strncmp_c8)(ptr, pn, (unsigned int)len) == 0) return yield; + pn += posix_name_lengths[yield] + 1; + yield++; + } +return -1; +} + + + +/************************************************* +* Read a subpattern or VERB name * +*************************************************/ + +/* This function is called from parse_regex() below whenever it needs to read +the name of a subpattern or a (*VERB) or an (*alpha_assertion). The initial +pointer must be to the character before the name. If that character is '*' we +are reading a verb or alpha assertion name. The pointer is updated to point +after the name, for a VERB or alpha assertion name, or after tha name's +terminator for a subpattern name. Returning both the offset and the name +pointer is redundant information, but some callers use one and some the other, +so it is simplest just to return both. + +Arguments: + ptrptr points to the character pointer variable + ptrend points to the end of the input string + utf true if the input is UTF-encoded + terminator the terminator of a subpattern name must be this + offsetptr where to put the offset from the start of the pattern + nameptr where to put a pointer to the name in the input + namelenptr where to put the length of the name + errcodeptr where to put an error code + cb pointer to the compile data block + +Returns: TRUE if a name was read + FALSE otherwise, with error code set +*/ + +static BOOL +read_name(PCRE2_SPTR *ptrptr, PCRE2_SPTR ptrend, BOOL utf, uint32_t terminator, + PCRE2_SIZE *offsetptr, PCRE2_SPTR *nameptr, uint32_t *namelenptr, + int *errorcodeptr, compile_block *cb) +{ +PCRE2_SPTR ptr = *ptrptr; +BOOL is_group = (*ptr != CHAR_ASTERISK); + +if (++ptr >= ptrend) /* No characters in name */ + { + *errorcodeptr = is_group? ERR62: /* Subpattern name expected */ + ERR60; /* Verb not recognized or malformed */ + goto FAILED; + } + +*nameptr = ptr; +*offsetptr = (PCRE2_SIZE)(ptr - cb->start_pattern); + +/* In UTF mode, a group name may contain letters and decimal digits as defined +by Unicode properties, and underscores, but must not start with a digit. */ + +#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE +if (utf && is_group) + { + uint32_t c, type; + + GETCHAR(c, ptr); + type = UCD_CHARTYPE(c); + + if (type == ucp_Nd) + { + *errorcodeptr = ERR44; + goto FAILED; + } + + for(;;) + { + if (type != ucp_Nd && PRIV(ucp_gentype)[type] != ucp_L && + c != CHAR_UNDERSCORE) break; + ptr++; + FORWARDCHARTEST(ptr, ptrend); + if (ptr >= ptrend) break; + GETCHAR(c, ptr); + type = UCD_CHARTYPE(c); + } + } +else +#else +(void)utf; /* Avoid compiler warning */ +#endif /* SUPPORT_UNICODE */ + +/* Handle non-group names and group names in non-UTF modes. A group name must +not start with a digit. If either of the others start with a digit it just +won't be recognized. */ + + { + if (is_group && IS_DIGIT(*ptr)) + { + *errorcodeptr = ERR44; + goto FAILED; + } + + while (ptr < ptrend && MAX_255(*ptr) && (cb->ctypes[*ptr] & ctype_word) != 0) + { + ptr++; + } + } + +/* Check name length */ + +if (ptr > *nameptr + MAX_NAME_SIZE) + { + *errorcodeptr = ERR48; + goto FAILED; + } +*namelenptr = (uint32_t)(ptr - *nameptr); + +/* Subpattern names must not be empty, and their terminator is checked here. +(What follows a verb or alpha assertion name is checked separately.) */ + +if (is_group) + { + if (ptr == *nameptr) + { + *errorcodeptr = ERR62; /* Subpattern name expected */ + goto FAILED; + } + if (ptr >= ptrend || *ptr != (PCRE2_UCHAR)terminator) + { + *errorcodeptr = ERR42; + goto FAILED; + } + ptr++; + } + +*ptrptr = ptr; +return TRUE; + +FAILED: +*ptrptr = ptr; +return FALSE; +} + + + +/************************************************* +* Manage callouts at start of cycle * +*************************************************/ + +/* At the start of a new item in parse_regex() we are able to record the +details of the previous item in a prior callout, and also to set up an +automatic callout if enabled. Avoid having two adjacent automatic callouts, +which would otherwise happen for items such as \Q that contribute nothing to +the parsed pattern. + +Arguments: + ptr current pattern pointer + pcalloutptr points to a pointer to previous callout, or NULL + auto_callout TRUE if auto_callouts are enabled + parsed_pattern the parsed pattern pointer + cb compile block + +Returns: possibly updated parsed_pattern pointer. +*/ + +static uint32_t * +manage_callouts(PCRE2_SPTR ptr, uint32_t **pcalloutptr, BOOL auto_callout, + uint32_t *parsed_pattern, compile_block *cb) +{ +uint32_t *previous_callout = *pcalloutptr; + +if (previous_callout != NULL) previous_callout[2] = (uint32_t)(ptr - + cb->start_pattern - (PCRE2_SIZE)previous_callout[1]); + +if (!auto_callout) previous_callout = NULL; else + { + if (previous_callout == NULL || + previous_callout != parsed_pattern - 4 || + previous_callout[3] != 255) + { + previous_callout = parsed_pattern; /* Set up new automatic callout */ + parsed_pattern += 4; + previous_callout[0] = META_CALLOUT_NUMBER; + previous_callout[2] = 0; + previous_callout[3] = 255; + } + previous_callout[1] = (uint32_t)(ptr - cb->start_pattern); + } + +*pcalloutptr = previous_callout; +return parsed_pattern; +} + + + +/************************************************* +* Parse regex and identify named groups * +*************************************************/ + +/* This function is called first of all. It scans the pattern and does two +things: (1) It identifies capturing groups and makes a table of named capturing +groups so that information about them is fully available to both the compiling +scans. (2) It writes a parsed version of the pattern with comments omitted and +escapes processed into the parsed_pattern vector. + +Arguments: + ptr points to the start of the pattern + options compiling dynamic options (may change during the scan) + has_lookbehind points to a boolean, set TRUE if a lookbehind is found + cb pointer to the compile data block + +Returns: zero on success or a non-zero error code, with the + error offset placed in the cb field +*/ + +/* A structure and some flags for dealing with nested groups. */ + +typedef struct nest_save { + uint16_t nest_depth; + uint16_t reset_group; + uint16_t max_group; + uint16_t flags; + uint32_t options; +} nest_save; + +#define NSF_RESET 0x0001u +#define NSF_CONDASSERT 0x0002u +#define NSF_ATOMICSR 0x0004u + +/* Options that are changeable within the pattern must be tracked during +parsing. Some (e.g. PCRE2_EXTENDED) are implemented entirely during parsing, +but all must be tracked so that META_OPTIONS items set the correct values for +the main compiling phase. */ + +#define PARSE_TRACKED_OPTIONS (PCRE2_CASELESS|PCRE2_DOTALL|PCRE2_DUPNAMES| \ + PCRE2_EXTENDED|PCRE2_EXTENDED_MORE|PCRE2_MULTILINE|PCRE2_NO_AUTO_CAPTURE| \ + PCRE2_UNGREEDY) + +/* States used for analyzing ranges in character classes. The two OK values +must be last. */ + +enum { RANGE_NO, RANGE_STARTED, RANGE_OK_ESCAPED, RANGE_OK_LITERAL }; + +/* Only in 32-bit mode can there be literals > META_END. A macro encapsulates +the storing of literal values in the main parsed pattern, where they can always +be quantified. */ + +#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 32 +#define PARSED_LITERAL(c, p) \ + { \ + if (c >= META_END) *p++ = META_BIGVALUE; \ + *p++ = c; \ + okquantifier = TRUE; \ + } +#else +#define PARSED_LITERAL(c, p) *p++ = c; okquantifier = TRUE; +#endif + +/* Here's the actual function. */ + +static int parse_regex(PCRE2_SPTR ptr, uint32_t options, BOOL *has_lookbehind, + compile_block *cb) +{ +uint32_t c; +uint32_t delimiter; +uint32_t namelen; +uint32_t class_range_state; +uint32_t *verblengthptr = NULL; /* Value avoids compiler warning */ +uint32_t *verbstartptr = NULL; +uint32_t *previous_callout = NULL; +uint32_t *parsed_pattern = cb->parsed_pattern; +uint32_t *parsed_pattern_end = cb->parsed_pattern_end; +uint32_t meta_quantifier = 0; +uint32_t add_after_mark = 0; +uint32_t extra_options = cb->cx->extra_options; +uint16_t nest_depth = 0; +int after_manual_callout = 0; +int expect_cond_assert = 0; +int errorcode = 0; +int escape; +int i; +BOOL inescq = FALSE; +BOOL inverbname = FALSE; +BOOL utf = (options & PCRE2_UTF) != 0; +BOOL auto_callout = (options & PCRE2_AUTO_CALLOUT) != 0; +BOOL isdupname; +BOOL negate_class; +BOOL okquantifier = FALSE; +PCRE2_SPTR thisptr; +PCRE2_SPTR name; +PCRE2_SPTR ptrend = cb->end_pattern; +PCRE2_SPTR verbnamestart = NULL; /* Value avoids compiler warning */ +named_group *ng; +nest_save *top_nest, *end_nests; + +/* Insert leading items for word and line matching (features provided for the +benefit of pcre2grep). */ + +if ((extra_options & PCRE2_EXTRA_MATCH_LINE) != 0) + { + *parsed_pattern++ = META_CIRCUMFLEX; + *parsed_pattern++ = META_NOCAPTURE; + } +else if ((extra_options & PCRE2_EXTRA_MATCH_WORD) != 0) + { + *parsed_pattern++ = META_ESCAPE + ESC_b; + *parsed_pattern++ = META_NOCAPTURE; + } + +/* If the pattern is actually a literal string, process it separately to avoid +cluttering up the main loop. */ + +if ((options & PCRE2_LITERAL) != 0) + { + while (ptr < ptrend) + { + if (parsed_pattern >= parsed_pattern_end) + { + errorcode = ERR63; /* Internal error (parsed pattern overflow) */ + goto FAILED; + } + thisptr = ptr; + GETCHARINCTEST(c, ptr); + if (auto_callout) + parsed_pattern = manage_callouts(thisptr, &previous_callout, + auto_callout, parsed_pattern, cb); + PARSED_LITERAL(c, parsed_pattern); + } + goto PARSED_END; + } + +/* Process a real regex which may contain meta-characters. */ + +top_nest = NULL; +end_nests = (nest_save *)(cb->start_workspace + cb->workspace_size); + +/* The size of the nest_save structure might not be a factor of the size of the +workspace. Therefore we must round down end_nests so as to correctly avoid +creating a nest_save that spans the end of the workspace. */ + +end_nests = (nest_save *)((char *)end_nests - + ((cb->workspace_size * sizeof(PCRE2_UCHAR)) % sizeof(nest_save))); + +/* PCRE2_EXTENDED_MORE implies PCRE2_EXTENDED */ + +if ((options & PCRE2_EXTENDED_MORE) != 0) options |= PCRE2_EXTENDED; + +/* Now scan the pattern */ + +while (ptr < ptrend) + { + int prev_expect_cond_assert; + uint32_t min_repeat = 0, max_repeat = 0; + uint32_t set, unset, *optset; + uint32_t terminator; + uint32_t prev_meta_quantifier; + BOOL prev_okquantifier; + PCRE2_SPTR tempptr; + PCRE2_SIZE offset; + + if (parsed_pattern >= parsed_pattern_end) + { + errorcode = ERR63; /* Internal error (parsed pattern overflow) */ + goto FAILED; + } + + if (nest_depth > cb->cx->parens_nest_limit) + { + errorcode = ERR19; + goto FAILED; /* Parentheses too deeply nested */ + } + + /* Get next input character, save its position for callout handling. */ + + thisptr = ptr; + GETCHARINCTEST(c, ptr); + + /* Copy quoted literals until \E, allowing for the possibility of automatic + callouts, except when processing a (*VERB) "name". */ + + if (inescq) + { + if (c == CHAR_BACKSLASH && ptr < ptrend && *ptr == CHAR_E) + { + inescq = FALSE; + ptr++; /* Skip E */ + } + else + { + if (expect_cond_assert > 0) /* A literal is not allowed if we are */ + { /* expecting a conditional assertion, */ + ptr--; /* but an empty \Q\E sequence is OK. */ + errorcode = ERR28; + goto FAILED; + } + if (inverbname) + { /* Don't use PARSED_LITERAL() because it */ +#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 32 /* sets okquantifier. */ + if (c >= META_END) *parsed_pattern++ = META_BIGVALUE; +#endif + *parsed_pattern++ = c; + } + else + { + if (after_manual_callout-- <= 0) + parsed_pattern = manage_callouts(thisptr, &previous_callout, + auto_callout, parsed_pattern, cb); + PARSED_LITERAL(c, parsed_pattern); + } + meta_quantifier = 0; + } + continue; /* Next character */ + } + + /* If we are processing the "name" part of a (*VERB:NAME) item, all + characters up to the closing parenthesis are literals except when + PCRE2_ALT_VERBNAMES is set. That causes backslash interpretation, but only \Q + and \E and escaped characters are allowed (no character types such as \d). If + PCRE2_EXTENDED is also set, we must ignore white space and # comments. Do + this by not entering the special (*VERB:NAME) processing - they are then + picked up below. Note that c is a character, not a code unit, so we must not + use MAX_255 to test its size because MAX_255 tests code units and is assumed + TRUE in 8-bit mode. */ + + if (inverbname && + ( + /* EITHER: not both options set */ + ((options & (PCRE2_EXTENDED | PCRE2_ALT_VERBNAMES)) != + (PCRE2_EXTENDED | PCRE2_ALT_VERBNAMES)) || +#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE + /* OR: character > 255 AND not Unicode Pattern White Space */ + (c > 255 && (c|1) != 0x200f && (c|1) != 0x2029) || +#endif + /* OR: not a # comment or isspace() white space */ + (c < 256 && c != CHAR_NUMBER_SIGN && (cb->ctypes[c] & ctype_space) == 0 +#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE + /* and not CHAR_NEL when Unicode is supported */ + && c != CHAR_NEL +#endif + ))) + { + PCRE2_SIZE verbnamelength; + + switch(c) + { + default: /* Don't use PARSED_LITERAL() because it */ +#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 32 /* sets okquantifier. */ + if (c >= META_END) *parsed_pattern++ = META_BIGVALUE; +#endif + *parsed_pattern++ = c; + break; + + case CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS: + inverbname = FALSE; + /* This is the length in characters */ + verbnamelength = (PCRE2_SIZE)(parsed_pattern - verblengthptr - 1); + /* But the limit on the length is in code units */ + if (ptr - verbnamestart - 1 > (int)MAX_MARK) + { + ptr--; + errorcode = ERR76; + goto FAILED; + } + *verblengthptr = (uint32_t)verbnamelength; + + /* If this name was on a verb such as (*ACCEPT) which does not continue, + a (*MARK) was generated for the name. We now add the original verb as the + next item. */ + + if (add_after_mark != 0) + { + *parsed_pattern++ = add_after_mark; + add_after_mark = 0; + } + break; + + case CHAR_BACKSLASH: + if ((options & PCRE2_ALT_VERBNAMES) != 0) + { + escape = PRIV(check_escape)(&ptr, ptrend, &c, &errorcode, options, + cb->cx->extra_options, FALSE, cb); + if (errorcode != 0) goto FAILED; + } + else escape = 0; /* Treat all as literal */ + + switch(escape) + { + case 0: /* Don't use PARSED_LITERAL() because it */ +#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 32 /* sets okquantifier. */ + if (c >= META_END) *parsed_pattern++ = META_BIGVALUE; +#endif + *parsed_pattern++ = c; + break; + + case ESC_Q: + inescq = TRUE; + break; + + case ESC_E: /* Ignore */ + break; + + default: + errorcode = ERR40; /* Invalid in verb name */ + goto FAILED; + } + } + continue; /* Next character in pattern */ + } + + /* Not a verb name character. At this point we must process everything that + must not change the quantification state. This is mainly comments, but we + handle \Q and \E here as well, so that an item such as A\Q\E+ is treated as + A+, as in Perl. An isolated \E is ignored. */ + + if (c == CHAR_BACKSLASH && ptr < ptrend) + { + if (*ptr == CHAR_Q || *ptr == CHAR_E) + { + inescq = *ptr == CHAR_Q; + ptr++; + continue; + } + } + + /* Skip over whitespace and # comments in extended mode. Note that c is a + character, not a code unit, so we must not use MAX_255 to test its size + because MAX_255 tests code units and is assumed TRUE in 8-bit mode. The + whitespace characters are those designated as "Pattern White Space" by + Unicode, which are the isspace() characters plus CHAR_NEL (newline), which is + U+0085 in Unicode, plus U+200E, U+200F, U+2028, and U+2029. These are a + subset of space characters that match \h and \v. */ + + if ((options & PCRE2_EXTENDED) != 0) + { + if (c < 256 && (cb->ctypes[c] & ctype_space) != 0) continue; +#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE + if (c == CHAR_NEL || (c|1) == 0x200f || (c|1) == 0x2029) continue; +#endif + if (c == CHAR_NUMBER_SIGN) + { + while (ptr < ptrend) + { + if (IS_NEWLINE(ptr)) /* For non-fixed-length newline cases, */ + { /* IS_NEWLINE sets cb->nllen. */ + ptr += cb->nllen; + break; + } + ptr++; +#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE + if (utf) FORWARDCHARTEST(ptr, ptrend); +#endif + } + continue; /* Next character in pattern */ + } + } + + /* Skip over bracketed comments */ + + if (c == CHAR_LEFT_PARENTHESIS && ptrend - ptr >= 2 && + ptr[0] == CHAR_QUESTION_MARK && ptr[1] == CHAR_NUMBER_SIGN) + { + while (++ptr < ptrend && *ptr != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS); + if (ptr >= ptrend) + { + errorcode = ERR18; /* A special error for missing ) in a comment */ + goto FAILED; /* to make it easier to debug. */ + } + ptr++; + continue; /* Next character in pattern */ + } + + /* If the next item is not a quantifier, fill in length of any previous + callout and create an auto callout if required. */ + + if (c != CHAR_ASTERISK && c != CHAR_PLUS && c != CHAR_QUESTION_MARK && + (c != CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET || + (tempptr = ptr, + !read_repeat_counts(&tempptr, ptrend, NULL, NULL, &errorcode)))) + { + if (after_manual_callout-- <= 0) + parsed_pattern = manage_callouts(thisptr, &previous_callout, auto_callout, + parsed_pattern, cb); + } + + /* If expect_cond_assert is 2, we have just passed (?( and are expecting an + assertion, possibly preceded by a callout. If the value is 1, we have just + had the callout and expect an assertion. There must be at least 3 more + characters in all cases. When expect_cond_assert is 2, we know that the + current character is an opening parenthesis, as otherwise we wouldn't be + here. However, when it is 1, we need to check, and it's easiest just to check + always. Note that expect_cond_assert may be negative, since all callouts just + decrement it. */ + + if (expect_cond_assert > 0) + { + BOOL ok = c == CHAR_LEFT_PARENTHESIS && ptrend - ptr >= 3 && + (ptr[0] == CHAR_QUESTION_MARK || ptr[0] == CHAR_ASTERISK); + if (ok) + { + if (ptr[0] == CHAR_ASTERISK) /* New alpha assertion format, possibly */ + { + ok = MAX_255(ptr[1]) && (cb->ctypes[ptr[1]] & ctype_lcletter) != 0; + } + else switch(ptr[1]) /* Traditional symbolic format */ + { + case CHAR_C: + ok = expect_cond_assert == 2; + break; + + case CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN: + case CHAR_EXCLAMATION_MARK: + break; + + case CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN: + ok = ptr[2] == CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN || ptr[2] == CHAR_EXCLAMATION_MARK; + break; + + default: + ok = FALSE; + } + } + + if (!ok) + { + ptr--; /* Adjust error offset */ + errorcode = ERR28; + goto FAILED; + } + } + + /* Remember whether we are expecting a conditional assertion, and set the + default for this item. */ + + prev_expect_cond_assert = expect_cond_assert; + expect_cond_assert = 0; + + /* Remember quantification status for the previous significant item, then set + default for this item. */ + + prev_okquantifier = okquantifier; + prev_meta_quantifier = meta_quantifier; + okquantifier = FALSE; + meta_quantifier = 0; + + /* If the previous significant item was a quantifier, adjust the parsed code + if there is a following modifier. The base meta value is always followed by + the PLUS and QUERY values, in that order. We do this here rather than after + reading a quantifier so that intervening comments and /x whitespace can be + ignored without having to replicate code. */ + + if (prev_meta_quantifier != 0 && (c == CHAR_QUESTION_MARK || c == CHAR_PLUS)) + { + parsed_pattern[(prev_meta_quantifier == META_MINMAX)? -3 : -1] = + prev_meta_quantifier + ((c == CHAR_QUESTION_MARK)? + 0x00020000u : 0x00010000u); + continue; /* Next character in pattern */ + } + + + /* Process the next item in the main part of a pattern. */ + + switch(c) + { + default: /* Non-special character */ + PARSED_LITERAL(c, parsed_pattern); + break; + + + /* ---- Escape sequence ---- */ + + case CHAR_BACKSLASH: + tempptr = ptr; + escape = PRIV(check_escape)(&ptr, ptrend, &c, &errorcode, options, + cb->cx->extra_options, FALSE, cb); + if (errorcode != 0) + { + ESCAPE_FAILED: + if ((extra_options & PCRE2_EXTRA_BAD_ESCAPE_IS_LITERAL) == 0) + goto FAILED; + ptr = tempptr; + if (ptr >= ptrend) c = CHAR_BACKSLASH; else + { + GETCHARINCTEST(c, ptr); /* Get character value, increment pointer */ + } + escape = 0; /* Treat as literal character */ + } + + /* The escape was a data escape or literal character. */ + + if (escape == 0) + { + PARSED_LITERAL(c, parsed_pattern); + } + + /* The escape was a back (or forward) reference. We keep the offset in + order to give a more useful diagnostic for a bad forward reference. For + references to groups numbered less than 10 we can't use more than two items + in parsed_pattern because they may be just two characters in the input (and + in a 64-bit world an offset may need two elements). So for them, the offset + of the first occurrent is held in a special vector. */ + + else if (escape < 0) + { + offset = (PCRE2_SIZE)(ptr - cb->start_pattern - 1); + escape = -escape; + *parsed_pattern++ = META_BACKREF | (uint32_t)escape; + if (escape < 10) + { + if (cb->small_ref_offset[escape] == PCRE2_UNSET) + cb->small_ref_offset[escape] = offset; + } + else + { + PUTOFFSET(offset, parsed_pattern); + } + okquantifier = TRUE; + } + + /* The escape was a character class such as \d etc. or other special + escape indicator such as \A or \X. Most of them generate just a single + parsed item, but \P and \p are followed by a 16-bit type and a 16-bit + value. They are supported only when Unicode is available. The type and + value are packed into a single 32-bit value so that the whole sequences + uses only two elements in the parsed_vector. This is because the same + coding is used if \d (for example) is turned into \p{Nd} when PCRE2_UCP is + set. + + There are also some cases where the escape sequence is followed by a name: + \k{name}, \k<name>, and \k'name' are backreferences by name, and \g<name> + and \g'name' are subroutine calls by name; \g{name} is a synonym for + \k{name}. Note that \g<number> and \g'number' are handled by check_escape() + and returned as a negative value (handled above). A name is coded as an + offset into the pattern and a length. */ + + else switch (escape) + { + case ESC_C: +#ifdef NEVER_BACKSLASH_C + errorcode = ERR85; + goto ESCAPE_FAILED; +#else + if ((options & PCRE2_NEVER_BACKSLASH_C) != 0) + { + errorcode = ERR83; + goto ESCAPE_FAILED; + } +#endif + okquantifier = TRUE; + *parsed_pattern++ = META_ESCAPE + escape; + break; + + case ESC_X: +#ifndef SUPPORT_UNICODE + errorcode = ERR45; /* Supported only with Unicode support */ + goto ESCAPE_FAILED; +#endif + case ESC_H: + case ESC_h: + case ESC_N: + case ESC_R: + case ESC_V: + case ESC_v: + okquantifier = TRUE; + *parsed_pattern++ = META_ESCAPE + escape; + break; + + default: /* \A, \B, \b, \G, \K, \Z, \z cannot be quantified. */ + *parsed_pattern++ = META_ESCAPE + escape; + break; + + /* Escapes that change in UCP mode. Note that PCRE2_UCP will never be set + without Unicode support because it is checked when pcre2_compile() is + called. */ + + case ESC_d: + case ESC_D: + case ESC_s: + case ESC_S: + case ESC_w: + case ESC_W: + okquantifier = TRUE; + if ((options & PCRE2_UCP) == 0) + { + *parsed_pattern++ = META_ESCAPE + escape; + } + else + { + *parsed_pattern++ = META_ESCAPE + + ((escape == ESC_d || escape == ESC_s || escape == ESC_w)? + ESC_p : ESC_P); + switch(escape) + { + case ESC_d: + case ESC_D: + *parsed_pattern++ = (PT_PC << 16) | ucp_Nd; + break; + + case ESC_s: + case ESC_S: + *parsed_pattern++ = PT_SPACE << 16; + break; + + case ESC_w: + case ESC_W: + *parsed_pattern++ = PT_WORD << 16; + break; + } + } + break; + + /* Unicode property matching */ + + case ESC_P: + case ESC_p: +#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE + { + BOOL negated; + uint16_t ptype = 0, pdata = 0; + if (!get_ucp(&ptr, &negated, &ptype, &pdata, &errorcode, cb)) + goto ESCAPE_FAILED; + if (negated) escape = (escape == ESC_P)? ESC_p : ESC_P; + *parsed_pattern++ = META_ESCAPE + escape; + *parsed_pattern++ = (ptype << 16) | pdata; + okquantifier = TRUE; + } +#else + errorcode = ERR45; + goto ESCAPE_FAILED; +#endif + break; /* End \P and \p */ + + /* When \g is used with quotes or angle brackets as delimiters, it is a + numerical or named subroutine call, and control comes here. When used + with brace delimiters it is a numberical back reference and does not come + here because check_escape() returns it directly as a reference. \k is + always a named back reference. */ + + case ESC_g: + case ESC_k: + if (ptr >= ptrend || (*ptr != CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET && + *ptr != CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN && *ptr != CHAR_APOSTROPHE)) + { + errorcode = (escape == ESC_g)? ERR57 : ERR69; + goto ESCAPE_FAILED; + } + terminator = (*ptr == CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN)? + CHAR_GREATER_THAN_SIGN : (*ptr == CHAR_APOSTROPHE)? + CHAR_APOSTROPHE : CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET; + + /* For a non-braced \g, check for a numerical recursion. */ + + if (escape == ESC_g && terminator != CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET) + { + PCRE2_SPTR p = ptr + 1; + + if (read_number(&p, ptrend, cb->bracount, MAX_GROUP_NUMBER, ERR61, &i, + &errorcode)) + { + if (p >= ptrend || *p != terminator) + { + errorcode = ERR57; + goto ESCAPE_FAILED; + } + ptr = p; + goto SET_RECURSION; + } + if (errorcode != 0) goto ESCAPE_FAILED; + } + + /* Not a numerical recursion */ + + if (!read_name(&ptr, ptrend, utf, terminator, &offset, &name, &namelen, + &errorcode, cb)) goto ESCAPE_FAILED; + + /* \k and \g when used with braces are back references, whereas \g used + with quotes or angle brackets is a recursion */ + + *parsed_pattern++ = + (escape == ESC_k || terminator == CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET)? + META_BACKREF_BYNAME : META_RECURSE_BYNAME; + *parsed_pattern++ = namelen; + + PUTOFFSET(offset, parsed_pattern); + okquantifier = TRUE; + break; /* End special escape processing */ + } + break; /* End escape sequence processing */ + + + /* ---- Single-character special items ---- */ + + case CHAR_CIRCUMFLEX_ACCENT: + *parsed_pattern++ = META_CIRCUMFLEX; + break; + + case CHAR_DOLLAR_SIGN: + *parsed_pattern++ = META_DOLLAR; + break; + + case CHAR_DOT: + *parsed_pattern++ = META_DOT; + okquantifier = TRUE; + break; + + + /* ---- Single-character quantifiers ---- */ + + case CHAR_ASTERISK: + meta_quantifier = META_ASTERISK; + goto CHECK_QUANTIFIER; + + case CHAR_PLUS: + meta_quantifier = META_PLUS; + goto CHECK_QUANTIFIER; + + case CHAR_QUESTION_MARK: + meta_quantifier = META_QUERY; + goto CHECK_QUANTIFIER; + + + /* ---- Potential {n,m} quantifier ---- */ + + case CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET: + if (!read_repeat_counts(&ptr, ptrend, &min_repeat, &max_repeat, + &errorcode)) + { + if (errorcode != 0) goto FAILED; /* Error in quantifier. */ + PARSED_LITERAL(c, parsed_pattern); /* Not a quantifier */ + break; /* No more quantifier processing */ + } + meta_quantifier = META_MINMAX; + /* Fall through */ + + + /* ---- Quantifier post-processing ---- */ + + /* Check that a quantifier is allowed after the previous item. */ + + CHECK_QUANTIFIER: + if (!prev_okquantifier) + { + errorcode = ERR9; + goto FAILED_BACK; + } + + /* Most (*VERB)s are not allowed to be quantified, but an ungreedy + quantifier can be useful for (*ACCEPT) - meaning "succeed on backtrack", a + sort of negated (*COMMIT). We therefore allow (*ACCEPT) to be quantified by + wrapping it in non-capturing brackets, but we have to allow for a preceding + (*MARK) for when (*ACCEPT) has an argument. */ + + if (parsed_pattern[-1] == META_ACCEPT) + { + uint32_t *p; + for (p = parsed_pattern - 1; p >= verbstartptr; p--) p[1] = p[0]; + *verbstartptr = META_NOCAPTURE; + parsed_pattern[1] = META_KET; + parsed_pattern += 2; + } + + /* Now we can put the quantifier into the parsed pattern vector. At this + stage, we have only the basic quantifier. The check for a following + or ? + modifier happens at the top of the loop, after any intervening comments + have been removed. */ + + *parsed_pattern++ = meta_quantifier; + if (c == CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET) + { + *parsed_pattern++ = min_repeat; + *parsed_pattern++ = max_repeat; + } + break; + + + /* ---- Character class ---- */ + + case CHAR_LEFT_SQUARE_BRACKET: + okquantifier = TRUE; + + /* In another (POSIX) regex library, the ugly syntax [[:<:]] and [[:>:]] is + used for "start of word" and "end of word". As these are otherwise illegal + sequences, we don't break anything by recognizing them. They are replaced + by \b(?=\w) and \b(?<=\w) respectively. Sequences like [a[:<:]] are + erroneous and are handled by the normal code below. */ + + if (ptrend - ptr >= 6 && + (PRIV(strncmp_c8)(ptr, STRING_WEIRD_STARTWORD, 6) == 0 || + PRIV(strncmp_c8)(ptr, STRING_WEIRD_ENDWORD, 6) == 0)) + { + *parsed_pattern++ = META_ESCAPE + ESC_b; + + if (ptr[2] == CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN) + { + *parsed_pattern++ = META_LOOKAHEAD; + } + else + { + *parsed_pattern++ = META_LOOKBEHIND; + *has_lookbehind = TRUE; + + /* The offset is used only for the "non-fixed length" error; this won't + occur here, so just store zero. */ + + PUTOFFSET((PCRE2_SIZE)0, parsed_pattern); + } + + if ((options & PCRE2_UCP) == 0) + *parsed_pattern++ = META_ESCAPE + ESC_w; + else + { + *parsed_pattern++ = META_ESCAPE + ESC_p; + *parsed_pattern++ = PT_WORD << 16; + } + *parsed_pattern++ = META_KET; + ptr += 6; + break; + } + + /* PCRE supports POSIX class stuff inside a class. Perl gives an error if + they are encountered at the top level, so we'll do that too. */ + + if (ptr < ptrend && (*ptr == CHAR_COLON || *ptr == CHAR_DOT || + *ptr == CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN) && + check_posix_syntax(ptr, ptrend, &tempptr)) + { + errorcode = (*ptr-- == CHAR_COLON)? ERR12 : ERR13; + goto FAILED; + } + + /* Process a regular character class. If the first character is '^', set + the negation flag. If the first few characters (either before or after ^) + are \Q\E or \E or space or tab in extended-more mode, we skip them too. + This makes for compatibility with Perl. */ + + negate_class = FALSE; + while (ptr < ptrend) + { + GETCHARINCTEST(c, ptr); + if (c == CHAR_BACKSLASH) + { + if (ptr < ptrend && *ptr == CHAR_E) ptr++; + else if (ptrend - ptr >= 3 && + PRIV(strncmp_c8)(ptr, STR_Q STR_BACKSLASH STR_E, 3) == 0) + ptr += 3; + else + break; + } + else if ((options & PCRE2_EXTENDED_MORE) != 0 && + (c == CHAR_SPACE || c == CHAR_HT)) /* Note: just these two */ + continue; + else if (!negate_class && c == CHAR_CIRCUMFLEX_ACCENT) + negate_class = TRUE; + else break; + } + + /* Now the real contents of the class; c has the first "real" character. + Empty classes are permitted only if the option is set. */ + + if (c == CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET && + (cb->external_options & PCRE2_ALLOW_EMPTY_CLASS) != 0) + { + *parsed_pattern++ = negate_class? META_CLASS_EMPTY_NOT : META_CLASS_EMPTY; + break; /* End of class processing */ + } + + /* Process a non-empty class. */ + + *parsed_pattern++ = negate_class? META_CLASS_NOT : META_CLASS; + class_range_state = RANGE_NO; + + /* In an EBCDIC environment, Perl treats alphabetic ranges specially + because there are holes in the encoding, and simply using the range A-Z + (for example) would include the characters in the holes. This applies only + to ranges where both values are literal; [\xC1-\xE9] is different to [A-Z] + in this respect. In order to accommodate this, we keep track of whether + character values are literal or not, and a state variable for handling + ranges. */ + + /* Loop for the contents of the class */ + + for (;;) + { + BOOL char_is_literal = TRUE; + + /* Inside \Q...\E everything is literal except \E */ + + if (inescq) + { + if (c == CHAR_BACKSLASH && ptr < ptrend && *ptr == CHAR_E) + { + inescq = FALSE; /* Reset literal state */ + ptr++; /* Skip the 'E' */ + goto CLASS_CONTINUE; + } + goto CLASS_LITERAL; + } + + /* Skip over space and tab (only) in extended-more mode. */ + + if ((options & PCRE2_EXTENDED_MORE) != 0 && + (c == CHAR_SPACE || c == CHAR_HT)) + goto CLASS_CONTINUE; + + /* Handle POSIX class names. Perl allows a negation extension of the + form [:^name:]. A square bracket that doesn't match the syntax is + treated as a literal. We also recognize the POSIX constructions + [.ch.] and [=ch=] ("collating elements") and fault them, as Perl + 5.6 and 5.8 do. */ + + if (c == CHAR_LEFT_SQUARE_BRACKET && + ptrend - ptr >= 3 && + (*ptr == CHAR_COLON || *ptr == CHAR_DOT || + *ptr == CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN) && + check_posix_syntax(ptr, ptrend, &tempptr)) + { + BOOL posix_negate = FALSE; + int posix_class; + + /* Perl treats a hyphen before a POSIX class as a literal, not the + start of a range. However, it gives a warning in its warning mode. PCRE + does not have a warning mode, so we give an error, because this is + likely an error on the user's part. */ + + if (class_range_state == RANGE_STARTED) + { + errorcode = ERR50; + goto FAILED; + } + + if (*ptr != CHAR_COLON) + { + errorcode = ERR13; + goto FAILED_BACK; + } + + if (*(++ptr) == CHAR_CIRCUMFLEX_ACCENT) + { + posix_negate = TRUE; + ptr++; + } + + posix_class = check_posix_name(ptr, (int)(tempptr - ptr)); + if (posix_class < 0) + { + errorcode = ERR30; + goto FAILED; + } + ptr = tempptr + 2; + + /* Perl treats a hyphen after a POSIX class as a literal, not the + start of a range. However, it gives a warning in its warning mode + unless the hyphen is the last character in the class. PCRE does not + have a warning mode, so we give an error, because this is likely an + error on the user's part. */ + + if (ptr < ptrend - 1 && *ptr == CHAR_MINUS && + ptr[1] != CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET) + { + errorcode = ERR50; + goto FAILED; + } + + /* Set "a hyphen is not the start of a range" for the -] case, and also + in case the POSIX class is followed by \E or \Q\E (possibly repeated - + fuzzers do that kind of thing) and *then* a hyphen. This causes that + hyphen to be treated as a literal. I don't think it's worth setting up + special apparatus to do otherwise. */ + + class_range_state = RANGE_NO; + + /* When PCRE2_UCP is set, some of the POSIX classes are converted to + use Unicode properties \p or \P or, in one case, \h or \H. The + substitutes table has two values per class, containing the type and + value of a \p or \P item. The special cases are specified with a + negative type: a non-zero value causes \h or \H to be used, and a zero + value falls through to behave like a non-UCP POSIX class. */ + +#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE + if ((options & PCRE2_UCP) != 0) + { + int ptype = posix_substitutes[2*posix_class]; + int pvalue = posix_substitutes[2*posix_class + 1]; + if (ptype >= 0) + { + *parsed_pattern++ = META_ESCAPE + (posix_negate? ESC_P : ESC_p); + *parsed_pattern++ = (ptype << 16) | pvalue; + goto CLASS_CONTINUE; + } + + if (pvalue != 0) + { + *parsed_pattern++ = META_ESCAPE + (posix_negate? ESC_H : ESC_h); + goto CLASS_CONTINUE; + } + + /* Fall through */ + } +#endif /* SUPPORT_UNICODE */ + + /* Non-UCP POSIX class */ + + *parsed_pattern++ = posix_negate? META_POSIX_NEG : META_POSIX; + *parsed_pattern++ = posix_class; + } + + /* Handle potential start of range */ + + else if (c == CHAR_MINUS && class_range_state >= RANGE_OK_ESCAPED) + { + *parsed_pattern++ = (class_range_state == RANGE_OK_LITERAL)? + META_RANGE_LITERAL : META_RANGE_ESCAPED; + class_range_state = RANGE_STARTED; + } + + /* Handle a literal character */ + + else if (c != CHAR_BACKSLASH) + { + CLASS_LITERAL: + if (class_range_state == RANGE_STARTED) + { + if (c == parsed_pattern[-2]) /* Optimize one-char range */ + parsed_pattern--; + else if (parsed_pattern[-2] > c) /* Check range is in order */ + { + errorcode = ERR8; + goto FAILED_BACK; + } + else + { + if (!char_is_literal && parsed_pattern[-1] == META_RANGE_LITERAL) + parsed_pattern[-1] = META_RANGE_ESCAPED; + PARSED_LITERAL(c, parsed_pattern); + } + class_range_state = RANGE_NO; + } + else /* Potential start of range */ + { + class_range_state = char_is_literal? + RANGE_OK_LITERAL : RANGE_OK_ESCAPED; + PARSED_LITERAL(c, parsed_pattern); + } + } + + /* Handle escapes in a class */ + + else + { + tempptr = ptr; + escape = PRIV(check_escape)(&ptr, ptrend, &c, &errorcode, options, + cb->cx->extra_options, TRUE, cb); + + if (errorcode != 0) + { + if ((extra_options & PCRE2_EXTRA_BAD_ESCAPE_IS_LITERAL) == 0) + goto FAILED; + ptr = tempptr; + if (ptr >= ptrend) c = CHAR_BACKSLASH; else + { + GETCHARINCTEST(c, ptr); /* Get character value, increment pointer */ + } + escape = 0; /* Treat as literal character */ + } + + switch(escape) + { + case 0: /* Escaped character code point is in c */ + char_is_literal = FALSE; + goto CLASS_LITERAL; + + case ESC_b: + c = CHAR_BS; /* \b is backspace in a class */ + char_is_literal = FALSE; + goto CLASS_LITERAL; + + case ESC_Q: + inescq = TRUE; /* Enter literal mode */ + goto CLASS_CONTINUE; + + case ESC_E: /* Ignore orphan \E */ + goto CLASS_CONTINUE; + + case ESC_B: /* Always an error in a class */ + case ESC_R: + case ESC_X: + errorcode = ERR7; + ptr--; + goto FAILED; + } + + /* The second part of a range can be a single-character escape + sequence (detected above), but not any of the other escapes. Perl + treats a hyphen as a literal in such circumstances. However, in Perl's + warning mode, a warning is given, so PCRE now faults it, as it is + almost certainly a mistake on the user's part. */ + + if (class_range_state == RANGE_STARTED) + { + errorcode = ERR50; + goto FAILED; /* Not CLASS_ESCAPE_FAILED; always an error */ + } + + /* Of the remaining escapes, only those that define characters are + allowed in a class. None may start a range. */ + + class_range_state = RANGE_NO; + switch(escape) + { + case ESC_N: + errorcode = ERR71; + goto FAILED; + + case ESC_H: + case ESC_h: + case ESC_V: + case ESC_v: + *parsed_pattern++ = META_ESCAPE + escape; + break; + + /* These escapes are converted to Unicode property tests when + PCRE2_UCP is set. */ + + case ESC_d: + case ESC_D: + case ESC_s: + case ESC_S: + case ESC_w: + case ESC_W: + if ((options & PCRE2_UCP) == 0) + { + *parsed_pattern++ = META_ESCAPE + escape; + } + else + { + *parsed_pattern++ = META_ESCAPE + + ((escape == ESC_d || escape == ESC_s || escape == ESC_w)? + ESC_p : ESC_P); + switch(escape) + { + case ESC_d: + case ESC_D: + *parsed_pattern++ = (PT_PC << 16) | ucp_Nd; + break; + + case ESC_s: + case ESC_S: + *parsed_pattern++ = PT_SPACE << 16; + break; + + case ESC_w: + case ESC_W: + *parsed_pattern++ = PT_WORD << 16; + break; + } + } + break; + + /* Explicit Unicode property matching */ + + case ESC_P: + case ESC_p: +#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE + { + BOOL negated; + uint16_t ptype = 0, pdata = 0; + if (!get_ucp(&ptr, &negated, &ptype, &pdata, &errorcode, cb)) + goto FAILED; + if (negated) escape = (escape == ESC_P)? ESC_p : ESC_P; + *parsed_pattern++ = META_ESCAPE + escape; + *parsed_pattern++ = (ptype << 16) | pdata; + } +#else + errorcode = ERR45; + goto FAILED; +#endif + break; /* End \P and \p */ + + default: /* All others are not allowed in a class */ + errorcode = ERR7; + ptr--; + goto FAILED; + } + + /* Perl gives a warning unless a following hyphen is the last character + in the class. PCRE throws an error. */ + + if (ptr < ptrend - 1 && *ptr == CHAR_MINUS && + ptr[1] != CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET) + { + errorcode = ERR50; + goto FAILED; + } + } + + /* Proceed to next thing in the class. */ + + CLASS_CONTINUE: + if (ptr >= ptrend) + { + errorcode = ERR6; /* Missing terminating ']' */ + goto FAILED; + } + GETCHARINCTEST(c, ptr); + if (c == CHAR_RIGHT_SQUARE_BRACKET && !inescq) break; + } /* End of class-processing loop */ + + /* -] at the end of a class is a literal '-' */ + + if (class_range_state == RANGE_STARTED) + { + parsed_pattern[-1] = CHAR_MINUS; + class_range_state = RANGE_NO; + } + + *parsed_pattern++ = META_CLASS_END; + break; /* End of character class */ + + + /* ---- Opening parenthesis ---- */ + + case CHAR_LEFT_PARENTHESIS: + if (ptr >= ptrend) goto UNCLOSED_PARENTHESIS; + + /* If ( is not followed by ? it is either a capture or a special verb or an + alpha assertion or a positive non-atomic lookahead. */ + + if (*ptr != CHAR_QUESTION_MARK) + { + const char *vn; + + /* Handle capturing brackets (or non-capturing if auto-capture is turned + off). */ + + if (*ptr != CHAR_ASTERISK) + { + nest_depth++; + if ((options & PCRE2_NO_AUTO_CAPTURE) == 0) + { + if (cb->bracount >= MAX_GROUP_NUMBER) + { + errorcode = ERR97; + goto FAILED; + } + cb->bracount++; + *parsed_pattern++ = META_CAPTURE | cb->bracount; + } + else *parsed_pattern++ = META_NOCAPTURE; + } + + /* Do nothing for (* followed by end of pattern or ) so it gives a "bad + quantifier" error rather than "(*MARK) must have an argument". */ + + else if (ptrend - ptr <= 1 || (c = ptr[1]) == CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS) + break; + + /* Handle "alpha assertions" such as (*pla:...). Most of these are + synonyms for the historical symbolic assertions, but the script run and + non-atomic lookaround ones are new. They are distinguished by starting + with a lower case letter. Checking both ends of the alphabet makes this + work in all character codes. */ + + else if (CHMAX_255(c) && (cb->ctypes[c] & ctype_lcletter) != 0) + { + uint32_t meta; + + vn = alasnames; + if (!read_name(&ptr, ptrend, utf, 0, &offset, &name, &namelen, + &errorcode, cb)) goto FAILED; + if (ptr >= ptrend || *ptr != CHAR_COLON) + { + errorcode = ERR95; /* Malformed */ + goto FAILED; + } + + /* Scan the table of alpha assertion names */ + + for (i = 0; i < alascount; i++) + { + if (namelen == alasmeta[i].len && + PRIV(strncmp_c8)(name, vn, namelen) == 0) + break; + vn += alasmeta[i].len + 1; + } + + if (i >= alascount) + { + errorcode = ERR95; /* Alpha assertion not recognized */ + goto FAILED; + } + + /* Check for expecting an assertion condition. If so, only atomic + lookaround assertions are valid. */ + + meta = alasmeta[i].meta; + if (prev_expect_cond_assert > 0 && + (meta < META_LOOKAHEAD || meta > META_LOOKBEHINDNOT)) + { + errorcode = (meta == META_LOOKAHEAD_NA || meta == META_LOOKBEHIND_NA)? + ERR98 : ERR28; /* (Atomic) assertion expected */ + goto FAILED; + } + + /* The lookaround alphabetic synonyms can mostly be handled by jumping + to the code that handles the traditional symbolic forms. */ + + switch(meta) + { + default: + errorcode = ERR89; /* Unknown code; should never occur because */ + goto FAILED; /* the meta values come from a table above. */ + + case META_ATOMIC: + goto ATOMIC_GROUP; + + case META_LOOKAHEAD: + goto POSITIVE_LOOK_AHEAD; + + case META_LOOKAHEAD_NA: + goto POSITIVE_NONATOMIC_LOOK_AHEAD; + + case META_LOOKAHEADNOT: + goto NEGATIVE_LOOK_AHEAD; + + case META_LOOKBEHIND: + case META_LOOKBEHINDNOT: + case META_LOOKBEHIND_NA: + *parsed_pattern++ = meta; + ptr--; + goto POST_LOOKBEHIND; + + /* The script run facilities are handled here. Unicode support is + required (give an error if not, as this is a security issue). Always + record a META_SCRIPT_RUN item. Then, for the atomic version, insert + META_ATOMIC and remember that we need two META_KETs at the end. */ + + case META_SCRIPT_RUN: + case META_ATOMIC_SCRIPT_RUN: +#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE + *parsed_pattern++ = META_SCRIPT_RUN; + nest_depth++; + ptr++; + if (meta == META_ATOMIC_SCRIPT_RUN) + { + *parsed_pattern++ = META_ATOMIC; + if (top_nest == NULL) top_nest = (nest_save *)(cb->start_workspace); + else if (++top_nest >= end_nests) + { + errorcode = ERR84; + goto FAILED; + } + top_nest->nest_depth = nest_depth; + top_nest->flags = NSF_ATOMICSR; + top_nest->options = options & PARSE_TRACKED_OPTIONS; + } + break; +#else /* SUPPORT_UNICODE */ + errorcode = ERR96; + goto FAILED; +#endif + } + } + + + /* ---- Handle (*VERB) and (*VERB:NAME) ---- */ + + else + { + vn = verbnames; + if (!read_name(&ptr, ptrend, utf, 0, &offset, &name, &namelen, + &errorcode, cb)) goto FAILED; + if (ptr >= ptrend || (*ptr != CHAR_COLON && + *ptr != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS)) + { + errorcode = ERR60; /* Malformed */ + goto FAILED; + } + + /* Scan the table of verb names */ + + for (i = 0; i < verbcount; i++) + { + if (namelen == verbs[i].len && + PRIV(strncmp_c8)(name, vn, namelen) == 0) + break; + vn += verbs[i].len + 1; + } + + if (i >= verbcount) + { + errorcode = ERR60; /* Verb not recognized */ + goto FAILED; + } + + /* An empty argument is treated as no argument. */ + + if (*ptr == CHAR_COLON && ptr + 1 < ptrend && + ptr[1] == CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS) + ptr++; /* Advance to the closing parens */ + + /* Check for mandatory non-empty argument; this is (*MARK) */ + + if (verbs[i].has_arg > 0 && *ptr != CHAR_COLON) + { + errorcode = ERR66; + goto FAILED; + } + + /* Remember where this verb, possibly with a preceding (*MARK), starts, + for handling quantified (*ACCEPT). */ + + verbstartptr = parsed_pattern; + okquantifier = (verbs[i].meta == META_ACCEPT); + + /* It appears that Perl allows any characters whatsoever, other than a + closing parenthesis, to appear in arguments ("names"), so we no longer + insist on letters, digits, and underscores. Perl does not, however, do + any interpretation within arguments, and has no means of including a + closing parenthesis. PCRE supports escape processing but only when it + is requested by an option. We set inverbname TRUE here, and let the + main loop take care of this so that escape and \x processing is done by + the main code above. */ + + if (*ptr++ == CHAR_COLON) /* Skip past : or ) */ + { + /* Some optional arguments can be treated as a preceding (*MARK) */ + + if (verbs[i].has_arg < 0) + { + add_after_mark = verbs[i].meta; + *parsed_pattern++ = META_MARK; + } + + /* The remaining verbs with arguments (except *MARK) need a different + opcode. */ + + else + { + *parsed_pattern++ = verbs[i].meta + + ((verbs[i].meta != META_MARK)? 0x00010000u:0); + } + + /* Set up for reading the name in the main loop. */ + + verblengthptr = parsed_pattern++; + verbnamestart = ptr; + inverbname = TRUE; + } + else /* No verb "name" argument */ + { + *parsed_pattern++ = verbs[i].meta; + } + } /* End of (*VERB) handling */ + break; /* Done with this parenthesis */ + } /* End of groups that don't start with (? */ + + + /* ---- Items starting (? ---- */ + + /* The type of item is determined by what follows (?. Handle (?| and option + changes under "default" because both need a new block on the nest stack. + Comments starting with (?# are handled above. Note that there is some + ambiguity about the sequence (?- because if a digit follows it's a relative + recursion or subroutine call whereas otherwise it's an option unsetting. */ + + if (++ptr >= ptrend) goto UNCLOSED_PARENTHESIS; + + switch(*ptr) + { + default: + if (*ptr == CHAR_MINUS && ptrend - ptr > 1 && IS_DIGIT(ptr[1])) + goto RECURSION_BYNUMBER; /* The + case is handled by CHAR_PLUS */ + + /* We now have either (?| or a (possibly empty) option setting, + optionally followed by a non-capturing group. */ + + nest_depth++; + if (top_nest == NULL) top_nest = (nest_save *)(cb->start_workspace); + else if (++top_nest >= end_nests) + { + errorcode = ERR84; + goto FAILED; + } + top_nest->nest_depth = nest_depth; + top_nest->flags = 0; + top_nest->options = options & PARSE_TRACKED_OPTIONS; + + /* Start of non-capturing group that resets the capture count for each + branch. */ + + if (*ptr == CHAR_VERTICAL_LINE) + { + top_nest->reset_group = (uint16_t)cb->bracount; + top_nest->max_group = (uint16_t)cb->bracount; + top_nest->flags |= NSF_RESET; + cb->external_flags |= PCRE2_DUPCAPUSED; + *parsed_pattern++ = META_NOCAPTURE; + ptr++; + } + + /* Scan for options imnsxJU to be set or unset. */ + + else + { + BOOL hyphenok = TRUE; + uint32_t oldoptions = options; + + top_nest->reset_group = 0; + top_nest->max_group = 0; + set = unset = 0; + optset = &set; + + /* ^ at the start unsets imnsx and disables the subsequent use of - */ + + if (ptr < ptrend && *ptr == CHAR_CIRCUMFLEX_ACCENT) + { + options &= ~(PCRE2_CASELESS|PCRE2_MULTILINE|PCRE2_NO_AUTO_CAPTURE| + PCRE2_DOTALL|PCRE2_EXTENDED|PCRE2_EXTENDED_MORE); + hyphenok = FALSE; + ptr++; + } + + while (ptr < ptrend && *ptr != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS && + *ptr != CHAR_COLON) + { + switch (*ptr++) + { + case CHAR_MINUS: + if (!hyphenok) + { + errorcode = ERR94; + ptr--; /* Correct the offset */ + goto FAILED; + } + optset = &unset; + hyphenok = FALSE; + break; + + case CHAR_J: /* Record that it changed in the external options */ + *optset |= PCRE2_DUPNAMES; + cb->external_flags |= PCRE2_JCHANGED; + break; + + case CHAR_i: *optset |= PCRE2_CASELESS; break; + case CHAR_m: *optset |= PCRE2_MULTILINE; break; + case CHAR_n: *optset |= PCRE2_NO_AUTO_CAPTURE; break; + case CHAR_s: *optset |= PCRE2_DOTALL; break; + case CHAR_U: *optset |= PCRE2_UNGREEDY; break; + + /* If x appears twice it sets the extended extended option. */ + + case CHAR_x: + *optset |= PCRE2_EXTENDED; + if (ptr < ptrend && *ptr == CHAR_x) + { + *optset |= PCRE2_EXTENDED_MORE; + ptr++; + } + break; + + default: + errorcode = ERR11; + ptr--; /* Correct the offset */ + goto FAILED; + } + } + + /* If we are setting extended without extended-more, ensure that any + existing extended-more gets unset. Also, unsetting extended must also + unset extended-more. */ + + if ((set & (PCRE2_EXTENDED|PCRE2_EXTENDED_MORE)) == PCRE2_EXTENDED || + (unset & PCRE2_EXTENDED) != 0) + unset |= PCRE2_EXTENDED_MORE; + + options = (options | set) & (~unset); + + /* If the options ended with ')' this is not the start of a nested + group with option changes, so the options change at this level. + In this case, if the previous level set up a nest block, discard the + one we have just created. Otherwise adjust it for the previous level. + If the options ended with ':' we are starting a non-capturing group, + possibly with an options setting. */ + + if (ptr >= ptrend) goto UNCLOSED_PARENTHESIS; + if (*ptr++ == CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS) + { + nest_depth--; /* This is not a nested group after all. */ + if (top_nest > (nest_save *)(cb->start_workspace) && + (top_nest-1)->nest_depth == nest_depth) top_nest--; + else top_nest->nest_depth = nest_depth; + } + else *parsed_pattern++ = META_NOCAPTURE; + + /* If nothing changed, no need to record. */ + + if (options != oldoptions) + { + *parsed_pattern++ = META_OPTIONS; + *parsed_pattern++ = options; + } + } /* End options processing */ + break; /* End default case after (? */ + + + /* ---- Python syntax support ---- */ + + case CHAR_P: + if (++ptr >= ptrend) goto UNCLOSED_PARENTHESIS; + + /* (?P<name> is the same as (?<name>, which defines a named group. */ + + if (*ptr == CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN) + { + terminator = CHAR_GREATER_THAN_SIGN; + goto DEFINE_NAME; + } + + /* (?P>name) is the same as (?&name), which is a recursion or subroutine + call. */ + + if (*ptr == CHAR_GREATER_THAN_SIGN) goto RECURSE_BY_NAME; + + /* (?P=name) is the same as \k<name>, a back reference by name. Anything + else after (?P is an error. */ + + if (*ptr != CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN) + { + errorcode = ERR41; + goto FAILED; + } + if (!read_name(&ptr, ptrend, utf, CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS, &offset, &name, + &namelen, &errorcode, cb)) goto FAILED; + *parsed_pattern++ = META_BACKREF_BYNAME; + *parsed_pattern++ = namelen; + PUTOFFSET(offset, parsed_pattern); + okquantifier = TRUE; + break; /* End of (?P processing */ + + + /* ---- Recursion/subroutine calls by number ---- */ + + case CHAR_R: + i = 0; /* (?R) == (?R0) */ + ptr++; + if (ptr >= ptrend || *ptr != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS) + { + errorcode = ERR58; + goto FAILED; + } + goto SET_RECURSION; + + /* An item starting (?- followed by a digit comes here via the "default" + case because (?- followed by a non-digit is an options setting. */ + + case CHAR_PLUS: + if (ptrend - ptr < 2 || !IS_DIGIT(ptr[1])) + { + errorcode = ERR29; /* Missing number */ + goto FAILED; + } + /* Fall through */ + + case CHAR_0: case CHAR_1: case CHAR_2: case CHAR_3: case CHAR_4: + case CHAR_5: case CHAR_6: case CHAR_7: case CHAR_8: case CHAR_9: + RECURSION_BYNUMBER: + if (!read_number(&ptr, ptrend, + (IS_DIGIT(*ptr))? -1:(int)(cb->bracount), /* + and - are relative */ + MAX_GROUP_NUMBER, ERR61, + &i, &errorcode)) goto FAILED; + if (i < 0) /* NB (?0) is permitted */ + { + errorcode = ERR15; /* Unknown group */ + goto FAILED_BACK; + } + if (ptr >= ptrend || *ptr != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS) + goto UNCLOSED_PARENTHESIS; + + SET_RECURSION: + *parsed_pattern++ = META_RECURSE | (uint32_t)i; + offset = (PCRE2_SIZE)(ptr - cb->start_pattern); + ptr++; + PUTOFFSET(offset, parsed_pattern); + okquantifier = TRUE; + break; /* End of recursive call by number handling */ + + + /* ---- Recursion/subroutine calls by name ---- */ + + case CHAR_AMPERSAND: + RECURSE_BY_NAME: + if (!read_name(&ptr, ptrend, utf, CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS, &offset, &name, + &namelen, &errorcode, cb)) goto FAILED; + *parsed_pattern++ = META_RECURSE_BYNAME; + *parsed_pattern++ = namelen; + PUTOFFSET(offset, parsed_pattern); + okquantifier = TRUE; + break; + + /* ---- Callout with numerical or string argument ---- */ + + case CHAR_C: + if (++ptr >= ptrend) goto UNCLOSED_PARENTHESIS; + + /* If the previous item was a condition starting (?(? an assertion, + optionally preceded by a callout, is expected. This is checked later on, + during actual compilation. However we need to identify this kind of + assertion in this pass because it must not be qualified. The value of + expect_cond_assert is set to 2 after (?(? is processed. We decrement it + for a callout - still leaving a positive value that identifies the + assertion. Multiple callouts or any other items will make it zero or + less, which doesn't matter because they will cause an error later. */ + + expect_cond_assert = prev_expect_cond_assert - 1; + + /* If previous_callout is not NULL, it means this follows a previous + callout. If it was a manual callout, do nothing; this means its "length + of next pattern item" field will remain zero. If it was an automatic + callout, abolish it. */ + + if (previous_callout != NULL && (options & PCRE2_AUTO_CALLOUT) != 0 && + previous_callout == parsed_pattern - 4 && + parsed_pattern[-1] == 255) + parsed_pattern = previous_callout; + + /* Save for updating next pattern item length, and skip one item before + completing. */ + + previous_callout = parsed_pattern; + after_manual_callout = 1; + + /* Handle a string argument; specific delimiter is required. */ + + if (*ptr != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS && !IS_DIGIT(*ptr)) + { + PCRE2_SIZE calloutlength; + PCRE2_SPTR startptr = ptr; + + delimiter = 0; + for (i = 0; PRIV(callout_start_delims)[i] != 0; i++) + { + if (*ptr == PRIV(callout_start_delims)[i]) + { + delimiter = PRIV(callout_end_delims)[i]; + break; + } + } + if (delimiter == 0) + { + errorcode = ERR82; + goto FAILED; + } + + *parsed_pattern = META_CALLOUT_STRING; + parsed_pattern += 3; /* Skip pattern info */ + + for (;;) + { + if (++ptr >= ptrend) + { + errorcode = ERR81; + ptr = startptr; /* To give a more useful message */ + goto FAILED; + } + if (*ptr == delimiter && (++ptr >= ptrend || *ptr != delimiter)) + break; + } + + calloutlength = (PCRE2_SIZE)(ptr - startptr); + if (calloutlength > UINT32_MAX) + { + errorcode = ERR72; + goto FAILED; + } + *parsed_pattern++ = (uint32_t)calloutlength; + offset = (PCRE2_SIZE)(startptr - cb->start_pattern); + PUTOFFSET(offset, parsed_pattern); + } + + /* Handle a callout with an optional numerical argument, which must be + less than or equal to 255. A missing argument gives 0. */ + + else + { + int n = 0; + *parsed_pattern = META_CALLOUT_NUMBER; /* Numerical callout */ + parsed_pattern += 3; /* Skip pattern info */ + while (ptr < ptrend && IS_DIGIT(*ptr)) + { + n = n * 10 + *ptr++ - CHAR_0; + if (n > 255) + { + errorcode = ERR38; + goto FAILED; + } + } + *parsed_pattern++ = n; + } + + /* Both formats must have a closing parenthesis */ + + if (ptr >= ptrend || *ptr != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS) + { + errorcode = ERR39; + goto FAILED; + } + ptr++; + + /* Remember the offset to the next item in the pattern, and set a default + length. This should get updated after the next item is read. */ + + previous_callout[1] = (uint32_t)(ptr - cb->start_pattern); + previous_callout[2] = 0; + break; /* End callout */ + + + /* ---- Conditional group ---- */ + + /* A condition can be an assertion, a number (referring to a numbered + group's having been set), a name (referring to a named group), or 'R', + referring to overall recursion. R<digits> and R&name are also permitted + for recursion state tests. Numbers may be preceded by + or - to specify a + relative group number. + + There are several syntaxes for testing a named group: (?(name)) is used + by Python; Perl 5.10 onwards uses (?(<name>) or (?('name')). + + There are two unfortunate ambiguities. 'R' can be the recursive thing or + the name 'R' (and similarly for 'R' followed by digits). 'DEFINE' can be + the Perl DEFINE feature or the Python named test. We look for a name + first; if not found, we try the other case. + + For compatibility with auto-callouts, we allow a callout to be specified + before a condition that is an assertion. */ + + case CHAR_LEFT_PARENTHESIS: + if (++ptr >= ptrend) goto UNCLOSED_PARENTHESIS; + nest_depth++; + + /* If the next character is ? or * there must be an assertion next + (optionally preceded by a callout). We do not check this here, but + instead we set expect_cond_assert to 2. If this is still greater than + zero (callouts decrement it) when the next assertion is read, it will be + marked as a condition that must not be repeated. A value greater than + zero also causes checking that an assertion (possibly with callout) + follows. */ + + if (*ptr == CHAR_QUESTION_MARK || *ptr == CHAR_ASTERISK) + { + *parsed_pattern++ = META_COND_ASSERT; + ptr--; /* Pull pointer back to the opening parenthesis. */ + expect_cond_assert = 2; + break; /* End of conditional */ + } + + /* Handle (?([+-]number)... */ + + if (read_number(&ptr, ptrend, cb->bracount, MAX_GROUP_NUMBER, ERR61, &i, + &errorcode)) + { + if (i <= 0) + { + errorcode = ERR15; + goto FAILED; + } + *parsed_pattern++ = META_COND_NUMBER; + offset = (PCRE2_SIZE)(ptr - cb->start_pattern - 2); + PUTOFFSET(offset, parsed_pattern); + *parsed_pattern++ = i; + } + else if (errorcode != 0) goto FAILED; /* Number too big */ + + /* No number found. Handle the special case (?(VERSION[>]=n.m)... */ + + else if (ptrend - ptr >= 10 && + PRIV(strncmp_c8)(ptr, STRING_VERSION, 7) == 0 && + ptr[7] != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS) + { + uint32_t ge = 0; + int major = 0; + int minor = 0; + + ptr += 7; + if (*ptr == CHAR_GREATER_THAN_SIGN) + { + ge = 1; + ptr++; + } + + /* NOTE: cannot write IS_DIGIT(*(++ptr)) here because IS_DIGIT + references its argument twice. */ + + if (*ptr != CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN || (ptr++, !IS_DIGIT(*ptr))) + goto BAD_VERSION_CONDITION; + + if (!read_number(&ptr, ptrend, -1, 1000, ERR79, &major, &errorcode)) + goto FAILED; + + if (ptr >= ptrend) goto BAD_VERSION_CONDITION; + if (*ptr == CHAR_DOT) + { + if (++ptr >= ptrend || !IS_DIGIT(*ptr)) goto BAD_VERSION_CONDITION; + minor = (*ptr++ - CHAR_0) * 10; + if (ptr >= ptrend) goto BAD_VERSION_CONDITION; + if (IS_DIGIT(*ptr)) minor += *ptr++ - CHAR_0; + if (ptr >= ptrend || *ptr != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS) + goto BAD_VERSION_CONDITION; + } + + *parsed_pattern++ = META_COND_VERSION; + *parsed_pattern++ = ge; + *parsed_pattern++ = major; + *parsed_pattern++ = minor; + } + + /* All the remaining cases now require us to read a name. We cannot at + this stage distinguish ambiguous cases such as (?(R12) which might be a + recursion test by number or a name, because the named groups have not yet + all been identified. Those cases are treated as names, but given a + different META code. */ + + else + { + BOOL was_r_ampersand = FALSE; + + if (*ptr == CHAR_R && ptrend - ptr > 1 && ptr[1] == CHAR_AMPERSAND) + { + terminator = CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS; + was_r_ampersand = TRUE; + ptr++; + } + else if (*ptr == CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN) + terminator = CHAR_GREATER_THAN_SIGN; + else if (*ptr == CHAR_APOSTROPHE) + terminator = CHAR_APOSTROPHE; + else + { + terminator = CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS; + ptr--; /* Point to char before name */ + } + if (!read_name(&ptr, ptrend, utf, terminator, &offset, &name, &namelen, + &errorcode, cb)) goto FAILED; + + /* Handle (?(R&name) */ + + if (was_r_ampersand) + { + *parsed_pattern = META_COND_RNAME; + ptr--; /* Back to closing parens */ + } + + /* Handle (?(name). If the name is "DEFINE" we identify it with a + special code. Likewise if the name consists of R followed only by + digits. Otherwise, handle it like a quoted name. */ + + else if (terminator == CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS) + { + if (namelen == 6 && PRIV(strncmp_c8)(name, STRING_DEFINE, 6) == 0) + *parsed_pattern = META_COND_DEFINE; + else + { + for (i = 1; i < (int)namelen; i++) + if (!IS_DIGIT(name[i])) break; + *parsed_pattern = (*name == CHAR_R && i >= (int)namelen)? + META_COND_RNUMBER : META_COND_NAME; + } + ptr--; /* Back to closing parens */ + } + + /* Handle (?('name') or (?(<name>) */ + + else *parsed_pattern = META_COND_NAME; + + /* All these cases except DEFINE end with the name length and offset; + DEFINE just has an offset (for the "too many branches" error). */ + + if (*parsed_pattern++ != META_COND_DEFINE) *parsed_pattern++ = namelen; + PUTOFFSET(offset, parsed_pattern); + } /* End cases that read a name */ + + /* Check the closing parenthesis of the condition */ + + if (ptr >= ptrend || *ptr != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS) + { + errorcode = ERR24; + goto FAILED; + } + ptr++; + break; /* End of condition processing */ + + + /* ---- Atomic group ---- */ + + case CHAR_GREATER_THAN_SIGN: + ATOMIC_GROUP: /* Come from (*atomic: */ + *parsed_pattern++ = META_ATOMIC; + nest_depth++; + ptr++; + break; + + + /* ---- Lookahead assertions ---- */ + + case CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN: + POSITIVE_LOOK_AHEAD: /* Come from (*pla: */ + *parsed_pattern++ = META_LOOKAHEAD; + ptr++; + goto POST_ASSERTION; + + case CHAR_ASTERISK: + POSITIVE_NONATOMIC_LOOK_AHEAD: /* Come from (?* */ + *parsed_pattern++ = META_LOOKAHEAD_NA; + ptr++; + goto POST_ASSERTION; + + case CHAR_EXCLAMATION_MARK: + NEGATIVE_LOOK_AHEAD: /* Come from (*nla: */ + *parsed_pattern++ = META_LOOKAHEADNOT; + ptr++; + goto POST_ASSERTION; + + + /* ---- Lookbehind assertions ---- */ + + /* (?< followed by = or ! or * is a lookbehind assertion. Otherwise (?< + is the start of the name of a capturing group. */ + + case CHAR_LESS_THAN_SIGN: + if (ptrend - ptr <= 1 || + (ptr[1] != CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN && + ptr[1] != CHAR_EXCLAMATION_MARK && + ptr[1] != CHAR_ASTERISK)) + { + terminator = CHAR_GREATER_THAN_SIGN; + goto DEFINE_NAME; + } + *parsed_pattern++ = (ptr[1] == CHAR_EQUALS_SIGN)? + META_LOOKBEHIND : (ptr[1] == CHAR_EXCLAMATION_MARK)? + META_LOOKBEHINDNOT : META_LOOKBEHIND_NA; + + POST_LOOKBEHIND: /* Come from (*plb: (*naplb: and (*nlb: */ + *has_lookbehind = TRUE; + offset = (PCRE2_SIZE)(ptr - cb->start_pattern - 2); + PUTOFFSET(offset, parsed_pattern); + ptr += 2; + /* Fall through */ + + /* If the previous item was a condition starting (?(? an assertion, + optionally preceded by a callout, is expected. This is checked later on, + during actual compilation. However we need to identify this kind of + assertion in this pass because it must not be qualified. The value of + expect_cond_assert is set to 2 after (?(? is processed. We decrement it + for a callout - still leaving a positive value that identifies the + assertion. Multiple callouts or any other items will make it zero or + less, which doesn't matter because they will cause an error later. */ + + POST_ASSERTION: + nest_depth++; + if (prev_expect_cond_assert > 0) + { + if (top_nest == NULL) top_nest = (nest_save *)(cb->start_workspace); + else if (++top_nest >= end_nests) + { + errorcode = ERR84; + goto FAILED; + } + top_nest->nest_depth = nest_depth; + top_nest->flags = NSF_CONDASSERT; + top_nest->options = options & PARSE_TRACKED_OPTIONS; + } + break; + + + /* ---- Define a named group ---- */ + + /* A named group may be defined as (?'name') or (?<name>). In the latter + case we jump to DEFINE_NAME from the disambiguation of (?< above with the + terminator set to '>'. */ + + case CHAR_APOSTROPHE: + terminator = CHAR_APOSTROPHE; /* Terminator */ + + DEFINE_NAME: + if (!read_name(&ptr, ptrend, utf, terminator, &offset, &name, &namelen, + &errorcode, cb)) goto FAILED; + + /* We have a name for this capturing group. It is also assigned a number, + which is its primary means of identification. */ + + if (cb->bracount >= MAX_GROUP_NUMBER) + { + errorcode = ERR97; + goto FAILED; + } + cb->bracount++; + *parsed_pattern++ = META_CAPTURE | cb->bracount; + nest_depth++; + + /* Check not too many names */ + + if (cb->names_found >= MAX_NAME_COUNT) + { + errorcode = ERR49; + goto FAILED; + } + + /* Adjust the entry size to accommodate the longest name found. */ + + if (namelen + IMM2_SIZE + 1 > cb->name_entry_size) + cb->name_entry_size = (uint16_t)(namelen + IMM2_SIZE + 1); + + /* Scan the list to check for duplicates. For duplicate names, if the + number is the same, break the loop, which causes the name to be + discarded; otherwise, if DUPNAMES is not set, give an error. + If it is set, allow the name with a different number, but continue + scanning in case this is a duplicate with the same number. For + non-duplicate names, give an error if the number is duplicated. */ + + isdupname = FALSE; + ng = cb->named_groups; + for (i = 0; i < cb->names_found; i++, ng++) + { + if (namelen == ng->length && + PRIV(strncmp)(name, ng->name, (PCRE2_SIZE)namelen) == 0) + { + if (ng->number == cb->bracount) break; + if ((options & PCRE2_DUPNAMES) == 0) + { + errorcode = ERR43; + goto FAILED; + } + isdupname = ng->isdup = TRUE; /* Mark as a duplicate */ + cb->dupnames = TRUE; /* Duplicate names exist */ + } + else if (ng->number == cb->bracount) + { + errorcode = ERR65; + goto FAILED; + } + } + + if (i < cb->names_found) break; /* Ignore duplicate with same number */ + + /* Increase the list size if necessary */ + + if (cb->names_found >= cb->named_group_list_size) + { + uint32_t newsize = cb->named_group_list_size * 2; + named_group *newspace = + cb->cx->memctl.malloc(newsize * sizeof(named_group), + cb->cx->memctl.memory_data); + if (newspace == NULL) + { + errorcode = ERR21; + goto FAILED; + } + + memcpy(newspace, cb->named_groups, + cb->named_group_list_size * sizeof(named_group)); + if (cb->named_group_list_size > NAMED_GROUP_LIST_SIZE) + cb->cx->memctl.free((void *)cb->named_groups, + cb->cx->memctl.memory_data); + cb->named_groups = newspace; + cb->named_group_list_size = newsize; + } + + /* Add this name to the list */ + + cb->named_groups[cb->names_found].name = name; + cb->named_groups[cb->names_found].length = (uint16_t)namelen; + cb->named_groups[cb->names_found].number = cb->bracount; + cb->named_groups[cb->names_found].isdup = (uint16_t)isdupname; + cb->names_found++; + break; + } /* End of (? switch */ + break; /* End of ( handling */ + + + /* ---- Branch terminators ---- */ + + /* Alternation: reset the capture count if we are in a (?| group. */ + + case CHAR_VERTICAL_LINE: + if (top_nest != NULL && top_nest->nest_depth == nest_depth && + (top_nest->flags & NSF_RESET) != 0) + { + if (cb->bracount > top_nest->max_group) + top_nest->max_group = (uint16_t)cb->bracount; + cb->bracount = top_nest->reset_group; + } + *parsed_pattern++ = META_ALT; + break; + + /* End of group; reset the capture count to the maximum if we are in a (?| + group and/or reset the options that are tracked during parsing. Disallow + quantifier for a condition that is an assertion. */ + + case CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS: + okquantifier = TRUE; + if (top_nest != NULL && top_nest->nest_depth == nest_depth) + { + options = (options & ~PARSE_TRACKED_OPTIONS) | top_nest->options; + if ((top_nest->flags & NSF_RESET) != 0 && + top_nest->max_group > cb->bracount) + cb->bracount = top_nest->max_group; + if ((top_nest->flags & NSF_CONDASSERT) != 0) + okquantifier = FALSE; + + if ((top_nest->flags & NSF_ATOMICSR) != 0) + { + *parsed_pattern++ = META_KET; + } + + if (top_nest == (nest_save *)(cb->start_workspace)) top_nest = NULL; + else top_nest--; + } + if (nest_depth == 0) /* Unmatched closing parenthesis */ + { + errorcode = ERR22; + goto FAILED_BACK; + } + nest_depth--; + *parsed_pattern++ = META_KET; + break; + } /* End of switch on pattern character */ + } /* End of main character scan loop */ + +/* End of pattern reached. Check for missing ) at the end of a verb name. */ + +if (inverbname && ptr >= ptrend) + { + errorcode = ERR60; + goto FAILED; + } + +/* Manage callout for the final item */ + +PARSED_END: +parsed_pattern = manage_callouts(ptr, &previous_callout, auto_callout, + parsed_pattern, cb); + +/* Insert trailing items for word and line matching (features provided for the +benefit of pcre2grep). */ + +if ((extra_options & PCRE2_EXTRA_MATCH_LINE) != 0) + { + *parsed_pattern++ = META_KET; + *parsed_pattern++ = META_DOLLAR; + } +else if ((extra_options & PCRE2_EXTRA_MATCH_WORD) != 0) + { + *parsed_pattern++ = META_KET; + *parsed_pattern++ = META_ESCAPE + ESC_b; + } + +/* Terminate the parsed pattern, then return success if all groups are closed. +Otherwise we have unclosed parentheses. */ + +if (parsed_pattern >= parsed_pattern_end) + { + errorcode = ERR63; /* Internal error (parsed pattern overflow) */ + goto FAILED; + } + +*parsed_pattern = META_END; +if (nest_depth == 0) return 0; + +UNCLOSED_PARENTHESIS: +errorcode = ERR14; + +/* Come here for all failures. */ + +FAILED: +cb->erroroffset = (PCRE2_SIZE)(ptr - cb->start_pattern); +return errorcode; + +/* Some errors need to indicate the previous character. */ + +FAILED_BACK: +ptr--; +goto FAILED; + +/* This failure happens several times. */ + +BAD_VERSION_CONDITION: +errorcode = ERR79; +goto FAILED; +} + + + +/************************************************* +* Find first significant opcode * +*************************************************/ + +/* This is called by several functions that scan a compiled expression looking +for a fixed first character, or an anchoring opcode etc. It skips over things +that do not influence this. For some calls, it makes sense to skip negative +forward and all backward assertions, and also the \b assertion; for others it +does not. + +Arguments: + code pointer to the start of the group + skipassert TRUE if certain assertions are to be skipped + +Returns: pointer to the first significant opcode +*/ + +static const PCRE2_UCHAR* +first_significant_code(PCRE2_SPTR code, BOOL skipassert) +{ +for (;;) + { + switch ((int)*code) + { + case OP_ASSERT_NOT: + case OP_ASSERTBACK: + case OP_ASSERTBACK_NOT: + case OP_ASSERTBACK_NA: + if (!skipassert) return code; + do code += GET(code, 1); while (*code == OP_ALT); + code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[*code]; + break; + + case OP_WORD_BOUNDARY: + case OP_NOT_WORD_BOUNDARY: + if (!skipassert) return code; + /* Fall through */ + + case OP_CALLOUT: + case OP_CREF: + case OP_DNCREF: + case OP_RREF: + case OP_DNRREF: + case OP_FALSE: + case OP_TRUE: + code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[*code]; + break; + + case OP_CALLOUT_STR: + code += GET(code, 1 + 2*LINK_SIZE); + break; + + case OP_SKIPZERO: + code += 2 + GET(code, 2) + LINK_SIZE; + break; + + case OP_COND: + case OP_SCOND: + if (code[1+LINK_SIZE] != OP_FALSE || /* Not DEFINE */ + code[GET(code, 1)] != OP_KET) /* More than one branch */ + return code; + code += GET(code, 1) + 1 + LINK_SIZE; + break; + + case OP_MARK: + case OP_COMMIT_ARG: + case OP_PRUNE_ARG: + case OP_SKIP_ARG: + case OP_THEN_ARG: + code += code[1] + PRIV(OP_lengths)[*code]; + break; + + default: + return code; + } + } +/* Control never reaches here */ +} + + + +#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE +/************************************************* +* Get othercase range * +*************************************************/ + +/* This function is passed the start and end of a class range in UCP mode. It +searches up the characters, looking for ranges of characters in the "other" +case. Each call returns the next one, updating the start address. A character +with multiple other cases is returned on its own with a special return value. + +Arguments: + cptr points to starting character value; updated + d end value + ocptr where to put start of othercase range + odptr where to put end of othercase range + +Yield: -1 when no more + 0 when a range is returned + >0 the CASESET offset for char with multiple other cases + in this case, ocptr contains the original +*/ + +static int +get_othercase_range(uint32_t *cptr, uint32_t d, uint32_t *ocptr, + uint32_t *odptr) +{ +uint32_t c, othercase, next; +unsigned int co; + +/* Find the first character that has an other case. If it has multiple other +cases, return its case offset value. */ + +for (c = *cptr; c <= d; c++) + { + if ((co = UCD_CASESET(c)) != 0) + { + *ocptr = c++; /* Character that has the set */ + *cptr = c; /* Rest of input range */ + return (int)co; + } + if ((othercase = UCD_OTHERCASE(c)) != c) break; + } + +if (c > d) return -1; /* Reached end of range */ + +/* Found a character that has a single other case. Search for the end of the +range, which is either the end of the input range, or a character that has zero +or more than one other cases. */ + +*ocptr = othercase; +next = othercase + 1; + +for (++c; c <= d; c++) + { + if ((co = UCD_CASESET(c)) != 0 || UCD_OTHERCASE(c) != next) break; + next++; + } + +*odptr = next - 1; /* End of othercase range */ +*cptr = c; /* Rest of input range */ +return 0; +} +#endif /* SUPPORT_UNICODE */ + + + +/************************************************* +* Add a character or range to a class (internal) * +*************************************************/ + +/* This function packages up the logic of adding a character or range of +characters to a class. The character values in the arguments will be within the +valid values for the current mode (8-bit, 16-bit, UTF, etc). This function is +called only from within the "add to class" group of functions, some of which +are recursive and mutually recursive. The external entry point is +add_to_class(). + +Arguments: + classbits the bit map for characters < 256 + uchardptr points to the pointer for extra data + options the options word + cb compile data + start start of range character + end end of range character + +Returns: the number of < 256 characters added + the pointer to extra data is updated +*/ + +static unsigned int +add_to_class_internal(uint8_t *classbits, PCRE2_UCHAR **uchardptr, + uint32_t options, compile_block *cb, uint32_t start, uint32_t end) +{ +uint32_t c; +uint32_t classbits_end = (end <= 0xff ? end : 0xff); +unsigned int n8 = 0; + +/* If caseless matching is required, scan the range and process alternate +cases. In Unicode, there are 8-bit characters that have alternate cases that +are greater than 255 and vice-versa. Sometimes we can just extend the original +range. */ + +if ((options & PCRE2_CASELESS) != 0) + { +#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE + if ((options & (PCRE2_UTF|PCRE2_UCP)) != 0) + { + int rc; + uint32_t oc, od; + + options &= ~PCRE2_CASELESS; /* Remove for recursive calls */ + c = start; + + while ((rc = get_othercase_range(&c, end, &oc, &od)) >= 0) + { + /* Handle a single character that has more than one other case. */ + + if (rc > 0) n8 += add_list_to_class_internal(classbits, uchardptr, options, cb, + PRIV(ucd_caseless_sets) + rc, oc); + + /* Do nothing if the other case range is within the original range. */ + + else if (oc >= cb->class_range_start && od <= cb->class_range_end) continue; + + /* Extend the original range if there is overlap, noting that if oc < c, we + can't have od > end because a subrange is always shorter than the basic + range. Otherwise, use a recursive call to add the additional range. */ + + else if (oc < start && od >= start - 1) start = oc; /* Extend downwards */ + else if (od > end && oc <= end + 1) + { + end = od; /* Extend upwards */ + if (end > classbits_end) classbits_end = (end <= 0xff ? end : 0xff); + } + else n8 += add_to_class_internal(classbits, uchardptr, options, cb, oc, od); + } + } + else +#endif /* SUPPORT_UNICODE */ + + /* Not UTF mode */ + + for (c = start; c <= classbits_end; c++) + { + SETBIT(classbits, cb->fcc[c]); + n8++; + } + } + +/* Now handle the originally supplied range. Adjust the final value according +to the bit length - this means that the same lists of (e.g.) horizontal spaces +can be used in all cases. */ + +if ((options & PCRE2_UTF) == 0 && end > MAX_NON_UTF_CHAR) + end = MAX_NON_UTF_CHAR; + +if (start > cb->class_range_start && end < cb->class_range_end) return n8; + +/* Use the bitmap for characters < 256. Otherwise use extra data.*/ + +for (c = start; c <= classbits_end; c++) + { + /* Regardless of start, c will always be <= 255. */ + SETBIT(classbits, c); + n8++; + } + +#ifdef SUPPORT_WIDE_CHARS +if (start <= 0xff) start = 0xff + 1; + +if (end >= start) + { + PCRE2_UCHAR *uchardata = *uchardptr; + +#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE + if ((options & PCRE2_UTF) != 0) + { + if (start < end) + { + *uchardata++ = XCL_RANGE; + uchardata += PRIV(ord2utf)(start, uchardata); + uchardata += PRIV(ord2utf)(end, uchardata); + } + else if (start == end) + { + *uchardata++ = XCL_SINGLE; + uchardata += PRIV(ord2utf)(start, uchardata); + } + } + else +#endif /* SUPPORT_UNICODE */ + + /* Without UTF support, character values are constrained by the bit length, + and can only be > 256 for 16-bit and 32-bit libraries. */ + +#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 8 + {} +#else + if (start < end) + { + *uchardata++ = XCL_RANGE; + *uchardata++ = start; + *uchardata++ = end; + } + else if (start == end) + { + *uchardata++ = XCL_SINGLE; + *uchardata++ = start; + } +#endif /* PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 8 */ + *uchardptr = uchardata; /* Updata extra data pointer */ + } +#else /* SUPPORT_WIDE_CHARS */ + (void)uchardptr; /* Avoid compiler warning */ +#endif /* SUPPORT_WIDE_CHARS */ + +return n8; /* Number of 8-bit characters */ +} + + + +#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE +/************************************************* +* Add a list of characters to a class (internal) * +*************************************************/ + +/* This function is used for adding a list of case-equivalent characters to a +class when in UTF mode. This function is called only from within +add_to_class_internal(), with which it is mutually recursive. + +Arguments: + classbits the bit map for characters < 256 + uchardptr points to the pointer for extra data + options the options word + cb contains pointers to tables etc. + p points to row of 32-bit values, terminated by NOTACHAR + except character to omit; this is used when adding lists of + case-equivalent characters to avoid including the one we + already know about + +Returns: the number of < 256 characters added + the pointer to extra data is updated +*/ + +static unsigned int +add_list_to_class_internal(uint8_t *classbits, PCRE2_UCHAR **uchardptr, + uint32_t options, compile_block *cb, const uint32_t *p, unsigned int except) +{ +unsigned int n8 = 0; +while (p[0] < NOTACHAR) + { + unsigned int n = 0; + if (p[0] != except) + { + while(p[n+1] == p[0] + n + 1) n++; + n8 += add_to_class_internal(classbits, uchardptr, options, cb, p[0], p[n]); + } + p += n + 1; + } +return n8; +} +#endif + + + +/************************************************* +* External entry point for add range to class * +*************************************************/ + +/* This function sets the overall range so that the internal functions can try +to avoid duplication when handling case-independence. + +Arguments: + classbits the bit map for characters < 256 + uchardptr points to the pointer for extra data + options the options word + cb compile data + start start of range character + end end of range character + +Returns: the number of < 256 characters added + the pointer to extra data is updated +*/ + +static unsigned int +add_to_class(uint8_t *classbits, PCRE2_UCHAR **uchardptr, uint32_t options, + compile_block *cb, uint32_t start, uint32_t end) +{ +cb->class_range_start = start; +cb->class_range_end = end; +return add_to_class_internal(classbits, uchardptr, options, cb, start, end); +} + + +/************************************************* +* External entry point for add list to class * +*************************************************/ + +/* This function is used for adding a list of horizontal or vertical whitespace +characters to a class. The list must be in order so that ranges of characters +can be detected and handled appropriately. This function sets the overall range +so that the internal functions can try to avoid duplication when handling +case-independence. + +Arguments: + classbits the bit map for characters < 256 + uchardptr points to the pointer for extra data + options the options word + cb contains pointers to tables etc. + p points to row of 32-bit values, terminated by NOTACHAR + except character to omit; this is used when adding lists of + case-equivalent characters to avoid including the one we + already know about + +Returns: the number of < 256 characters added + the pointer to extra data is updated +*/ + +static unsigned int +add_list_to_class(uint8_t *classbits, PCRE2_UCHAR **uchardptr, uint32_t options, + compile_block *cb, const uint32_t *p, unsigned int except) +{ +unsigned int n8 = 0; +while (p[0] < NOTACHAR) + { + unsigned int n = 0; + if (p[0] != except) + { + while(p[n+1] == p[0] + n + 1) n++; + cb->class_range_start = p[0]; + cb->class_range_end = p[n]; + n8 += add_to_class_internal(classbits, uchardptr, options, cb, p[0], p[n]); + } + p += n + 1; + } +return n8; +} + + + +/************************************************* +* Add characters not in a list to a class * +*************************************************/ + +/* This function is used for adding the complement of a list of horizontal or +vertical whitespace to a class. The list must be in order. + +Arguments: + classbits the bit map for characters < 256 + uchardptr points to the pointer for extra data + options the options word + cb contains pointers to tables etc. + p points to row of 32-bit values, terminated by NOTACHAR + +Returns: the number of < 256 characters added + the pointer to extra data is updated +*/ + +static unsigned int +add_not_list_to_class(uint8_t *classbits, PCRE2_UCHAR **uchardptr, + uint32_t options, compile_block *cb, const uint32_t *p) +{ +BOOL utf = (options & PCRE2_UTF) != 0; +unsigned int n8 = 0; +if (p[0] > 0) + n8 += add_to_class(classbits, uchardptr, options, cb, 0, p[0] - 1); +while (p[0] < NOTACHAR) + { + while (p[1] == p[0] + 1) p++; + n8 += add_to_class(classbits, uchardptr, options, cb, p[0] + 1, + (p[1] == NOTACHAR) ? (utf ? 0x10ffffu : 0xffffffffu) : p[1] - 1); + p++; + } +return n8; +} + + + +/************************************************* +* Find details of duplicate group names * +*************************************************/ + +/* This is called from compile_branch() when it needs to know the index and +count of duplicates in the names table when processing named backreferences, +either directly, or as conditions. + +Arguments: + name points to the name + length the length of the name + indexptr where to put the index + countptr where to put the count of duplicates + errorcodeptr where to put an error code + cb the compile block + +Returns: TRUE if OK, FALSE if not, error code set +*/ + +static BOOL +find_dupname_details(PCRE2_SPTR name, uint32_t length, int *indexptr, + int *countptr, int *errorcodeptr, compile_block *cb) +{ +uint32_t i, groupnumber; +int count; +PCRE2_UCHAR *slot = cb->name_table; + +/* Find the first entry in the table */ + +for (i = 0; i < cb->names_found; i++) + { + if (PRIV(strncmp)(name, slot+IMM2_SIZE, length) == 0 && + slot[IMM2_SIZE+length] == 0) break; + slot += cb->name_entry_size; + } + +/* This should not occur, because this function is called only when we know we +have duplicate names. Give an internal error. */ + +if (i >= cb->names_found) + { + *errorcodeptr = ERR53; + cb->erroroffset = name - cb->start_pattern; + return FALSE; + } + +/* Record the index and then see how many duplicates there are, updating the +backref map and maximum back reference as we do. */ + +*indexptr = i; +count = 0; + +for (;;) + { + count++; + groupnumber = GET2(slot,0); + cb->backref_map |= (groupnumber < 32)? (1u << groupnumber) : 1; + if (groupnumber > cb->top_backref) cb->top_backref = groupnumber; + if (++i >= cb->names_found) break; + slot += cb->name_entry_size; + if (PRIV(strncmp)(name, slot+IMM2_SIZE, length) != 0 || + (slot+IMM2_SIZE)[length] != 0) break; + } + +*countptr = count; +return TRUE; +} + + + +/************************************************* +* Compile one branch * +*************************************************/ + +/* Scan the parsed pattern, compiling it into the a vector of PCRE2_UCHAR. If +the options are changed during the branch, the pointer is used to change the +external options bits. This function is used during the pre-compile phase when +we are trying to find out the amount of memory needed, as well as during the +real compile phase. The value of lengthptr distinguishes the two phases. + +Arguments: + optionsptr pointer to the option bits + codeptr points to the pointer to the current code point + pptrptr points to the current parsed pattern pointer + errorcodeptr points to error code variable + firstcuptr place to put the first required code unit + firstcuflagsptr place to put the first code unit flags + reqcuptr place to put the last required code unit + reqcuflagsptr place to put the last required code unit flags + bcptr points to current branch chain + cb contains pointers to tables etc. + lengthptr NULL during the real compile phase + points to length accumulator during pre-compile phase + +Returns: 0 There's been an error, *errorcodeptr is non-zero + +1 Success, this branch must match at least one character + -1 Success, this branch may match an empty string +*/ + +static int +compile_branch(uint32_t *optionsptr, PCRE2_UCHAR **codeptr, uint32_t **pptrptr, + int *errorcodeptr, uint32_t *firstcuptr, uint32_t *firstcuflagsptr, + uint32_t *reqcuptr, uint32_t *reqcuflagsptr, branch_chain *bcptr, + compile_block *cb, PCRE2_SIZE *lengthptr) +{ +int bravalue = 0; +int okreturn = -1; +int group_return = 0; +uint32_t repeat_min = 0, repeat_max = 0; /* To please picky compilers */ +uint32_t greedy_default, greedy_non_default; +uint32_t repeat_type, op_type; +uint32_t options = *optionsptr; /* May change dynamically */ +uint32_t firstcu, reqcu; +uint32_t zeroreqcu, zerofirstcu; +uint32_t escape; +uint32_t *pptr = *pptrptr; +uint32_t meta, meta_arg; +uint32_t firstcuflags, reqcuflags; +uint32_t zeroreqcuflags, zerofirstcuflags; +uint32_t req_caseopt, reqvary, tempreqvary; +PCRE2_SIZE offset = 0; +PCRE2_SIZE length_prevgroup = 0; +PCRE2_UCHAR *code = *codeptr; +PCRE2_UCHAR *last_code = code; +PCRE2_UCHAR *orig_code = code; +PCRE2_UCHAR *tempcode; +PCRE2_UCHAR *previous = NULL; +PCRE2_UCHAR op_previous; +BOOL groupsetfirstcu = FALSE; +BOOL had_accept = FALSE; +BOOL matched_char = FALSE; +BOOL previous_matched_char = FALSE; +BOOL reset_caseful = FALSE; +const uint8_t *cbits = cb->cbits; +uint8_t classbits[32]; + +/* We can fish out the UTF setting once and for all into a BOOL, but we must +not do this for other options (e.g. PCRE2_EXTENDED) because they may change +dynamically as we process the pattern. */ + +#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE +BOOL utf = (options & PCRE2_UTF) != 0; +BOOL ucp = (options & PCRE2_UCP) != 0; +#else /* No Unicode support */ +BOOL utf = FALSE; +#endif + +/* Helper variables for OP_XCLASS opcode (for characters > 255). We define +class_uchardata always so that it can be passed to add_to_class() always, +though it will not be used in non-UTF 8-bit cases. This avoids having to supply +alternative calls for the different cases. */ + +PCRE2_UCHAR *class_uchardata; +#ifdef SUPPORT_WIDE_CHARS +BOOL xclass; +PCRE2_UCHAR *class_uchardata_base; +#endif + +/* Set up the default and non-default settings for greediness */ + +greedy_default = ((options & PCRE2_UNGREEDY) != 0); +greedy_non_default = greedy_default ^ 1; + +/* Initialize no first unit, no required unit. REQ_UNSET means "no char +matching encountered yet". It gets changed to REQ_NONE if we hit something that +matches a non-fixed first unit; reqcu just remains unset if we never find one. + +When we hit a repeat whose minimum is zero, we may have to adjust these values +to take the zero repeat into account. This is implemented by setting them to +zerofirstcu and zeroreqcu when such a repeat is encountered. The individual +item types that can be repeated set these backoff variables appropriately. */ + +firstcu = reqcu = zerofirstcu = zeroreqcu = 0; +firstcuflags = reqcuflags = zerofirstcuflags = zeroreqcuflags = REQ_UNSET; + +/* The variable req_caseopt contains either the REQ_CASELESS bit or zero, +according to the current setting of the caseless flag. The REQ_CASELESS value +leaves the lower 28 bit empty. It is added into the firstcu or reqcu variables +to record the case status of the value. This is used only for ASCII characters. +*/ + +req_caseopt = ((options & PCRE2_CASELESS) != 0)? REQ_CASELESS : 0; + +/* Switch on next META item until the end of the branch */ + +for (;; pptr++) + { +#ifdef SUPPORT_WIDE_CHARS + BOOL xclass_has_prop; +#endif + BOOL negate_class; + BOOL should_flip_negation; + BOOL match_all_or_no_wide_chars; + BOOL possessive_quantifier; + BOOL note_group_empty; + int class_has_8bitchar; + uint32_t mclength; + uint32_t skipunits; + uint32_t subreqcu, subfirstcu; + uint32_t groupnumber; + uint32_t verbarglen, verbculen; + uint32_t subreqcuflags, subfirstcuflags; + open_capitem *oc; + PCRE2_UCHAR mcbuffer[8]; + + /* Get next META item in the pattern and its potential argument. */ + + meta = META_CODE(*pptr); + meta_arg = META_DATA(*pptr); + + /* If we are in the pre-compile phase, accumulate the length used for the + previous cycle of this loop, unless the next item is a quantifier. */ + + if (lengthptr != NULL) + { + if (code > cb->start_workspace + cb->workspace_size - + WORK_SIZE_SAFETY_MARGIN) /* Check for overrun */ + { + *errorcodeptr = (code >= cb->start_workspace + cb->workspace_size)? + ERR52 : ERR86; + return 0; + } + + /* There is at least one situation where code goes backwards: this is the + case of a zero quantifier after a class (e.g. [ab]{0}). When the quantifier + is processed, the whole class is eliminated. However, it is created first, + so we have to allow memory for it. Therefore, don't ever reduce the length + at this point. */ + + if (code < last_code) code = last_code; + + /* If the next thing is not a quantifier, we add the length of the previous + item into the total, and reset the code pointer to the start of the + workspace. Otherwise leave the previous item available to be quantified. */ + + if (meta < META_ASTERISK || meta > META_MINMAX_QUERY) + { + if (OFLOW_MAX - *lengthptr < (PCRE2_SIZE)(code - orig_code)) + { + *errorcodeptr = ERR20; /* Integer overflow */ + return 0; + } + *lengthptr += (PCRE2_SIZE)(code - orig_code); + if (*lengthptr > MAX_PATTERN_SIZE) + { + *errorcodeptr = ERR20; /* Pattern is too large */ + return 0; + } + code = orig_code; + } + + /* Remember where this code item starts so we can catch the "backwards" + case above next time round. */ + + last_code = code; + } + + /* Process the next parsed pattern item. If it is not a quantifier, remember + where it starts so that it can be quantified when a quantifier follows. + Checking for the legality of quantifiers happens in parse_regex(), except for + a quantifier after an assertion that is a condition. */ + + if (meta < META_ASTERISK || meta > META_MINMAX_QUERY) + { + previous = code; + if (matched_char && !had_accept) okreturn = 1; + } + + previous_matched_char = matched_char; + matched_char = FALSE; + note_group_empty = FALSE; + skipunits = 0; /* Default value for most subgroups */ + + switch(meta) + { + /* ===================================================================*/ + /* The branch terminates at pattern end or | or ) */ + + case META_END: + case META_ALT: + case META_KET: + *firstcuptr = firstcu; + *firstcuflagsptr = firstcuflags; + *reqcuptr = reqcu; + *reqcuflagsptr = reqcuflags; + *codeptr = code; + *pptrptr = pptr; + return okreturn; + + + /* ===================================================================*/ + /* Handle single-character metacharacters. In multiline mode, ^ disables + the setting of any following char as a first character. */ + + case META_CIRCUMFLEX: + if ((options & PCRE2_MULTILINE) != 0) + { + if (firstcuflags == REQ_UNSET) + zerofirstcuflags = firstcuflags = REQ_NONE; + *code++ = OP_CIRCM; + } + else *code++ = OP_CIRC; + break; + + case META_DOLLAR: + *code++ = ((options & PCRE2_MULTILINE) != 0)? OP_DOLLM : OP_DOLL; + break; + + /* There can never be a first char if '.' is first, whatever happens about + repeats. The value of reqcu doesn't change either. */ + + case META_DOT: + matched_char = TRUE; + if (firstcuflags == REQ_UNSET) firstcuflags = REQ_NONE; + zerofirstcu = firstcu; + zerofirstcuflags = firstcuflags; + zeroreqcu = reqcu; + zeroreqcuflags = reqcuflags; + *code++ = ((options & PCRE2_DOTALL) != 0)? OP_ALLANY: OP_ANY; + break; + + + /* ===================================================================*/ + /* Empty character classes are allowed if PCRE2_ALLOW_EMPTY_CLASS is set. + Otherwise, an initial ']' is taken as a data character. When empty classes + are allowed, [] must always fail, so generate OP_FAIL, whereas [^] must + match any character, so generate OP_ALLANY. */ + + case META_CLASS_EMPTY: + case META_CLASS_EMPTY_NOT: + matched_char = TRUE; + *code++ = (meta == META_CLASS_EMPTY_NOT)? OP_ALLANY : OP_FAIL; + if (firstcuflags == REQ_UNSET) firstcuflags = REQ_NONE; + zerofirstcu = firstcu; + zerofirstcuflags = firstcuflags; + break; + + + /* ===================================================================*/ + /* Non-empty character class. If the included characters are all < 256, we + build a 32-byte bitmap of the permitted characters, except in the special + case where there is only one such character. For negated classes, we build + the map as usual, then invert it at the end. However, we use a different + opcode so that data characters > 255 can be handled correctly. + + If the class contains characters outside the 0-255 range, a different + opcode is compiled. It may optionally have a bit map for characters < 256, + but those above are are explicitly listed afterwards. A flag code unit + tells whether the bitmap is present, and whether this is a negated class or + not. */ + + case META_CLASS_NOT: + case META_CLASS: + matched_char = TRUE; + negate_class = meta == META_CLASS_NOT; + + /* We can optimize the case of a single character in a class by generating + OP_CHAR or OP_CHARI if it's positive, or OP_NOT or OP_NOTI if it's + negative. In the negative case there can be no first char if this item is + first, whatever repeat count may follow. In the case of reqcu, save the + previous value for reinstating. */ + + /* NOTE: at present this optimization is not effective if the only + character in a class in 32-bit, non-UCP mode has its top bit set. */ + + if (pptr[1] < META_END && pptr[2] == META_CLASS_END) + { +#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE + uint32_t d; +#endif + uint32_t c = pptr[1]; + + pptr += 2; /* Move on to class end */ + if (meta == META_CLASS) /* A positive one-char class can be */ + { /* handled as a normal literal character. */ + meta = c; /* Set up the character */ + goto NORMAL_CHAR_SET; + } + + /* Handle a negative one-character class */ + + zeroreqcu = reqcu; + zeroreqcuflags = reqcuflags; + if (firstcuflags == REQ_UNSET) firstcuflags = REQ_NONE; + zerofirstcu = firstcu; + zerofirstcuflags = firstcuflags; + + /* For caseless UTF or UCP mode, check whether this character has more + than one other case. If so, generate a special OP_NOTPROP item instead of + OP_NOTI. */ + +#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE + if ((utf||ucp) && (options & PCRE2_CASELESS) != 0 && + (d = UCD_CASESET(c)) != 0) + { + *code++ = OP_NOTPROP; + *code++ = PT_CLIST; + *code++ = d; + break; /* We are finished with this class */ + } +#endif + /* Char has only one other case, or UCP not available */ + + *code++ = ((options & PCRE2_CASELESS) != 0)? OP_NOTI: OP_NOT; + code += PUTCHAR(c, code); + break; /* We are finished with this class */ + } /* End of 1-char optimization */ + + /* Handle character classes that contain more than just one literal + character. If there are exactly two characters in a positive class, see if + they are case partners. This can be optimized to generate a caseless single + character match (which also sets first/required code units if relevant). */ + + if (meta == META_CLASS && pptr[1] < META_END && pptr[2] < META_END && + pptr[3] == META_CLASS_END) + { + uint32_t c = pptr[1]; + +#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE + if (UCD_CASESET(c) == 0) +#endif + { + uint32_t d; + +#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE + if ((utf || ucp) && c > 127) d = UCD_OTHERCASE(c); else +#endif + { +#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH != 8 + if (c > 255) d = c; else +#endif + d = TABLE_GET(c, cb->fcc, c); + } + + if (c != d && pptr[2] == d) + { + pptr += 3; /* Move on to class end */ + meta = c; + if ((options & PCRE2_CASELESS) == 0) + { + reset_caseful = TRUE; + options |= PCRE2_CASELESS; + req_caseopt = REQ_CASELESS; + } + goto CLASS_CASELESS_CHAR; + } + } + } + + /* If a non-extended class contains a negative special such as \S, we need + to flip the negation flag at the end, so that support for characters > 255 + works correctly (they are all included in the class). An extended class may + need to insert specific matching or non-matching code for wide characters. + */ + + should_flip_negation = match_all_or_no_wide_chars = FALSE; + + /* Extended class (xclass) will be used when characters > 255 + might match. */ + +#ifdef SUPPORT_WIDE_CHARS + xclass = FALSE; + class_uchardata = code + LINK_SIZE + 2; /* For XCLASS items */ + class_uchardata_base = class_uchardata; /* Save the start */ +#endif + + /* For optimization purposes, we track some properties of the class: + class_has_8bitchar will be non-zero if the class contains at least one + character with a code point less than 256; xclass_has_prop will be TRUE if + Unicode property checks are present in the class. */ + + class_has_8bitchar = 0; +#ifdef SUPPORT_WIDE_CHARS + xclass_has_prop = FALSE; +#endif + + /* Initialize the 256-bit (32-byte) bit map to all zeros. We build the map + in a temporary bit of memory, in case the class contains fewer than two + 8-bit characters because in that case the compiled code doesn't use the bit + map. */ + + memset(classbits, 0, 32 * sizeof(uint8_t)); + + /* Process items until META_CLASS_END is reached. */ + + while ((meta = *(++pptr)) != META_CLASS_END) + { + /* Handle POSIX classes such as [:alpha:] etc. */ + + if (meta == META_POSIX || meta == META_POSIX_NEG) + { + BOOL local_negate = (meta == META_POSIX_NEG); + int posix_class = *(++pptr); + int taboffset, tabopt; + uint8_t pbits[32]; + + should_flip_negation = local_negate; /* Note negative special */ + + /* If matching is caseless, upper and lower are converted to alpha. + This relies on the fact that the class table starts with alpha, + lower, upper as the first 3 entries. */ + + if ((options & PCRE2_CASELESS) != 0 && posix_class <= 2) + posix_class = 0; + + /* When PCRE2_UCP is set, some of the POSIX classes are converted to + different escape sequences that use Unicode properties \p or \P. + Others that are not available via \p or \P have to generate + XCL_PROP/XCL_NOTPROP directly, which is done here. */ + +#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE + if ((options & PCRE2_UCP) != 0) switch(posix_class) + { + case PC_GRAPH: + case PC_PRINT: + case PC_PUNCT: + *class_uchardata++ = local_negate? XCL_NOTPROP : XCL_PROP; + *class_uchardata++ = (PCRE2_UCHAR) + ((posix_class == PC_GRAPH)? PT_PXGRAPH : + (posix_class == PC_PRINT)? PT_PXPRINT : PT_PXPUNCT); + *class_uchardata++ = 0; + xclass_has_prop = TRUE; + goto CONTINUE_CLASS; + + /* For the other POSIX classes (ascii, xdigit) we are going to + fall through to the non-UCP case and build a bit map for + characters with code points less than 256. However, if we are in + a negated POSIX class, characters with code points greater than + 255 must either all match or all not match, depending on whether + the whole class is not or is negated. For example, for + [[:^ascii:]... they must all match, whereas for [^[:^xdigit:]... + they must not. + + In the special case where there are no xclass items, this is + automatically handled by the use of OP_CLASS or OP_NCLASS, but an + explicit range is needed for OP_XCLASS. Setting a flag here + causes the range to be generated later when it is known that + OP_XCLASS is required. In the 8-bit library this is relevant only in + utf mode, since no wide characters can exist otherwise. */ + + default: +#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 8 + if (utf) +#endif + match_all_or_no_wide_chars |= local_negate; + break; + } +#endif /* SUPPORT_UNICODE */ + + /* In the non-UCP case, or when UCP makes no difference, we build the + bit map for the POSIX class in a chunk of local store because we may + be adding and subtracting from it, and we don't want to subtract bits + that may be in the main map already. At the end we or the result into + the bit map that is being built. */ + + posix_class *= 3; + + /* Copy in the first table (always present) */ + + memcpy(pbits, cbits + posix_class_maps[posix_class], + 32 * sizeof(uint8_t)); + + /* If there is a second table, add or remove it as required. */ + + taboffset = posix_class_maps[posix_class + 1]; + tabopt = posix_class_maps[posix_class + 2]; + + if (taboffset >= 0) + { + if (tabopt >= 0) + for (int i = 0; i < 32; i++) pbits[i] |= cbits[(int)i + taboffset]; + else + for (int i = 0; i < 32; i++) pbits[i] &= ~cbits[(int)i + taboffset]; + } + + /* Now see if we need to remove any special characters. An option + value of 1 removes vertical space and 2 removes underscore. */ + + if (tabopt < 0) tabopt = -tabopt; + if (tabopt == 1) pbits[1] &= ~0x3c; + else if (tabopt == 2) pbits[11] &= 0x7f; + + /* Add the POSIX table or its complement into the main table that is + being built and we are done. */ + + if (local_negate) + for (int i = 0; i < 32; i++) classbits[i] |= (uint8_t)(~pbits[i]); + else + for (int i = 0; i < 32; i++) classbits[i] |= pbits[i]; + + /* Every class contains at least one < 256 character. */ + + class_has_8bitchar = 1; + goto CONTINUE_CLASS; /* End of POSIX handling */ + } + + /* Other than POSIX classes, the only items we should encounter are + \d-type escapes and literal characters (possibly as ranges). */ + + if (meta == META_BIGVALUE) + { + meta = *(++pptr); + goto CLASS_LITERAL; + } + + /* Any other non-literal must be an escape */ + + if (meta >= META_END) + { + if (META_CODE(meta) != META_ESCAPE) + { +#ifdef DEBUG_SHOW_PARSED + fprintf(stderr, "** Unrecognized parsed pattern item 0x%.8x " + "in character class\n", meta); +#endif + *errorcodeptr = ERR89; /* Internal error - unrecognized. */ + return 0; + } + escape = META_DATA(meta); + + /* Every class contains at least one < 256 character. */ + + class_has_8bitchar++; + + switch(escape) + { + case ESC_d: + for (int i = 0; i < 32; i++) classbits[i] |= cbits[i+cbit_digit]; + break; + + case ESC_D: + should_flip_negation = TRUE; + for (int i = 0; i < 32; i++) + classbits[i] |= (uint8_t)(~cbits[i+cbit_digit]); + break; + + case ESC_w: + for (int i = 0; i < 32; i++) classbits[i] |= cbits[i+cbit_word]; + break; + + case ESC_W: + should_flip_negation = TRUE; + for (int i = 0; i < 32; i++) + classbits[i] |= (uint8_t)(~cbits[i+cbit_word]); + break; + + /* Perl 5.004 onwards omitted VT from \s, but restored it at Perl + 5.18. Before PCRE 8.34, we had to preserve the VT bit if it was + previously set by something earlier in the character class. + Luckily, the value of CHAR_VT is 0x0b in both ASCII and EBCDIC, so + we could just adjust the appropriate bit. From PCRE 8.34 we no + longer treat \s and \S specially. */ + + case ESC_s: + for (int i = 0; i < 32; i++) classbits[i] |= cbits[i+cbit_space]; + break; + + case ESC_S: + should_flip_negation = TRUE; + for (int i = 0; i < 32; i++) + classbits[i] |= (uint8_t)(~cbits[i+cbit_space]); + break; + + /* When adding the horizontal or vertical space lists to a class, or + their complements, disable PCRE2_CASELESS, because it justs wastes + time, and in the "not-x" UTF cases can create unwanted duplicates in + the XCLASS list (provoked by characters that have more than one other + case and by both cases being in the same "not-x" sublist). */ + + case ESC_h: + (void)add_list_to_class(classbits, &class_uchardata, + options & ~PCRE2_CASELESS, cb, PRIV(hspace_list), NOTACHAR); + break; + + case ESC_H: + (void)add_not_list_to_class(classbits, &class_uchardata, + options & ~PCRE2_CASELESS, cb, PRIV(hspace_list)); + break; + + case ESC_v: + (void)add_list_to_class(classbits, &class_uchardata, + options & ~PCRE2_CASELESS, cb, PRIV(vspace_list), NOTACHAR); + break; + + case ESC_V: + (void)add_not_list_to_class(classbits, &class_uchardata, + options & ~PCRE2_CASELESS, cb, PRIV(vspace_list)); + break; + + /* If Unicode is not supported, \P and \p are not allowed and are + faulted at parse time, so will never appear here. */ + +#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE + case ESC_p: + case ESC_P: + { + uint32_t ptype = *(++pptr) >> 16; + uint32_t pdata = *pptr & 0xffff; + *class_uchardata++ = (escape == ESC_p)? XCL_PROP : XCL_NOTPROP; + *class_uchardata++ = ptype; + *class_uchardata++ = pdata; + xclass_has_prop = TRUE; + class_has_8bitchar--; /* Undo! */ + } + break; +#endif + } + + goto CONTINUE_CLASS; + } /* End handling \d-type escapes */ + + /* A literal character may be followed by a range meta. At parse time + there are checks for out-of-order characters, for ranges where the two + characters are equal, and for hyphens that cannot indicate a range. At + this point, therefore, no checking is needed. */ + + else + { + uint32_t c, d; + + CLASS_LITERAL: + c = d = meta; + + /* Remember if \r or \n were explicitly used */ + + if (c == CHAR_CR || c == CHAR_NL) cb->external_flags |= PCRE2_HASCRORLF; + + /* Process a character range */ + + if (pptr[1] == META_RANGE_LITERAL || pptr[1] == META_RANGE_ESCAPED) + { +#ifdef EBCDIC + BOOL range_is_literal = (pptr[1] == META_RANGE_LITERAL); +#endif + pptr += 2; + d = *pptr; + if (d == META_BIGVALUE) d = *(++pptr); + + /* Remember an explicit \r or \n, and add the range to the class. */ + + if (d == CHAR_CR || d == CHAR_NL) cb->external_flags |= PCRE2_HASCRORLF; + + /* In an EBCDIC environment, Perl treats alphabetic ranges specially + because there are holes in the encoding, and simply using the range + A-Z (for example) would include the characters in the holes. This + applies only to literal ranges; [\xC1-\xE9] is different to [A-Z]. */ + +#ifdef EBCDIC + if (range_is_literal && + (cb->ctypes[c] & ctype_letter) != 0 && + (cb->ctypes[d] & ctype_letter) != 0 && + (c <= CHAR_z) == (d <= CHAR_z)) + { + uint32_t uc = (d <= CHAR_z)? 0 : 64; + uint32_t C = c - uc; + uint32_t D = d - uc; + + if (C <= CHAR_i) + { + class_has_8bitchar += + add_to_class(classbits, &class_uchardata, options, cb, C + uc, + ((D < CHAR_i)? D : CHAR_i) + uc); + C = CHAR_j; + } + + if (C <= D && C <= CHAR_r) + { + class_has_8bitchar += + add_to_class(classbits, &class_uchardata, options, cb, C + uc, + ((D < CHAR_r)? D : CHAR_r) + uc); + C = CHAR_s; + } + + if (C <= D) + { + class_has_8bitchar += + add_to_class(classbits, &class_uchardata, options, cb, C + uc, + D + uc); + } + } + else +#endif + /* Not an EBCDIC special range */ + + class_has_8bitchar += + add_to_class(classbits, &class_uchardata, options, cb, c, d); + goto CONTINUE_CLASS; /* Go get the next char in the class */ + } /* End of range handling */ + + + /* Handle a single character. */ + + class_has_8bitchar += + add_to_class(classbits, &class_uchardata, options, cb, meta, meta); + } + + /* Continue to the next item in the class. */ + + CONTINUE_CLASS: + +#ifdef SUPPORT_WIDE_CHARS + /* If any wide characters or Unicode properties have been encountered, + set xclass = TRUE. Then, in the pre-compile phase, accumulate the length + of the extra data and reset the pointer. This is so that very large + classes that contain a zillion wide characters or Unicode property tests + do not overwrite the workspace (which is on the stack). */ + + if (class_uchardata > class_uchardata_base) + { + xclass = TRUE; + if (lengthptr != NULL) + { + *lengthptr += class_uchardata - class_uchardata_base; + class_uchardata = class_uchardata_base; + } + } +#endif + + continue; /* Needed to avoid error when not supporting wide chars */ + } /* End of main class-processing loop */ + + /* If this class is the first thing in the branch, there can be no first + char setting, whatever the repeat count. Any reqcu setting must remain + unchanged after any kind of repeat. */ + + if (firstcuflags == REQ_UNSET) firstcuflags = REQ_NONE; + zerofirstcu = firstcu; + zerofirstcuflags = firstcuflags; + zeroreqcu = reqcu; + zeroreqcuflags = reqcuflags; + + /* If there are characters with values > 255, or Unicode property settings + (\p or \P), we have to compile an extended class, with its own opcode, + unless there were no property settings and there was a negated special such + as \S in the class, and PCRE2_UCP is not set, because in that case all + characters > 255 are in or not in the class, so any that were explicitly + given as well can be ignored. + + In the UCP case, if certain negated POSIX classes ([:^ascii:] or + [^:xdigit:]) were present in a class, we either have to match or not match + all wide characters (depending on whether the whole class is or is not + negated). This requirement is indicated by match_all_or_no_wide_chars being + true. We do this by including an explicit range, which works in both cases. + This applies only in UTF and 16-bit and 32-bit non-UTF modes, since there + cannot be any wide characters in 8-bit non-UTF mode. + + When there *are* properties in a positive UTF-8 or any 16-bit or 32_bit + class where \S etc is present without PCRE2_UCP, causing an extended class + to be compiled, we make sure that all characters > 255 are included by + forcing match_all_or_no_wide_chars to be true. + + If, when generating an xclass, there are no characters < 256, we can omit + the bitmap in the actual compiled code. */ + +#ifdef SUPPORT_WIDE_CHARS /* Defined for 16/32 bits, or 8-bit with Unicode */ + if (xclass && ( +#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE + (options & PCRE2_UCP) != 0 || +#endif + xclass_has_prop || !should_flip_negation)) + { + if (match_all_or_no_wide_chars || ( +#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 8 + utf && +#endif + should_flip_negation && !negate_class && (options & PCRE2_UCP) == 0)) + { + *class_uchardata++ = XCL_RANGE; + if (utf) /* Will always be utf in the 8-bit library */ + { + class_uchardata += PRIV(ord2utf)(0x100, class_uchardata); + class_uchardata += PRIV(ord2utf)(MAX_UTF_CODE_POINT, class_uchardata); + } + else /* Can only happen for the 16-bit & 32-bit libraries */ + { +#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 16 + *class_uchardata++ = 0x100; + *class_uchardata++ = 0xffffu; +#elif PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 32 + *class_uchardata++ = 0x100; + *class_uchardata++ = 0xffffffffu; +#endif + } + } + *class_uchardata++ = XCL_END; /* Marks the end of extra data */ + *code++ = OP_XCLASS; + code += LINK_SIZE; + *code = negate_class? XCL_NOT:0; + if (xclass_has_prop) *code |= XCL_HASPROP; + + /* If the map is required, move up the extra data to make room for it; + otherwise just move the code pointer to the end of the extra data. */ + + if (class_has_8bitchar > 0) + { + *code++ |= XCL_MAP; + (void)memmove(code + (32 / sizeof(PCRE2_UCHAR)), code, + CU2BYTES(class_uchardata - code)); + if (negate_class && !xclass_has_prop) + { + /* Using 255 ^ instead of ~ avoids clang sanitize warning. */ + for (int i = 0; i < 32; i++) classbits[i] = 255 ^ classbits[i]; + } + memcpy(code, classbits, 32); + code = class_uchardata + (32 / sizeof(PCRE2_UCHAR)); + } + else code = class_uchardata; + + /* Now fill in the complete length of the item */ + + PUT(previous, 1, (int)(code - previous)); + break; /* End of class handling */ + } +#endif /* SUPPORT_WIDE_CHARS */ + + /* If there are no characters > 255, or they are all to be included or + excluded, set the opcode to OP_CLASS or OP_NCLASS, depending on whether the + whole class was negated and whether there were negative specials such as \S + (non-UCP) in the class. Then copy the 32-byte map into the code vector, + negating it if necessary. */ + + *code++ = (negate_class == should_flip_negation) ? OP_CLASS : OP_NCLASS; + if (lengthptr == NULL) /* Save time in the pre-compile phase */ + { + if (negate_class) + { + /* Using 255 ^ instead of ~ avoids clang sanitize warning. */ + for (int i = 0; i < 32; i++) classbits[i] = 255 ^ classbits[i]; + } + memcpy(code, classbits, 32); + } + code += 32 / sizeof(PCRE2_UCHAR); + break; /* End of class processing */ + + + /* ===================================================================*/ + /* Deal with (*VERB)s. */ + + /* Check for open captures before ACCEPT and close those that are within + the same assertion level, also converting ACCEPT to ASSERT_ACCEPT in an + assertion. In the first pass, just accumulate the length required; + otherwise hitting (*ACCEPT) inside many nested parentheses can cause + workspace overflow. Do not set firstcu after *ACCEPT. */ + + case META_ACCEPT: + cb->had_accept = had_accept = TRUE; + for (oc = cb->open_caps; + oc != NULL && oc->assert_depth >= cb->assert_depth; + oc = oc->next) + { + if (lengthptr != NULL) + { + *lengthptr += CU2BYTES(1) + IMM2_SIZE; + } + else + { + *code++ = OP_CLOSE; + PUT2INC(code, 0, oc->number); + } + } + *code++ = (cb->assert_depth > 0)? OP_ASSERT_ACCEPT : OP_ACCEPT; + if (firstcuflags == REQ_UNSET) firstcuflags = REQ_NONE; + break; + + case META_PRUNE: + case META_SKIP: + cb->had_pruneorskip = TRUE; + /* Fall through */ + case META_COMMIT: + case META_FAIL: + *code++ = verbops[(meta - META_MARK) >> 16]; + break; + + case META_THEN: + cb->external_flags |= PCRE2_HASTHEN; + *code++ = OP_THEN; + break; + + /* Handle verbs with arguments. Arguments can be very long, especially in + 16- and 32-bit modes, and can overflow the workspace in the first pass. + However, the argument length is constrained to be small enough to fit in + one code unit. This check happens in parse_regex(). In the first pass, + instead of putting the argument into memory, we just update the length + counter and set up an empty argument. */ + + case META_THEN_ARG: + cb->external_flags |= PCRE2_HASTHEN; + goto VERB_ARG; + + case META_PRUNE_ARG: + case META_SKIP_ARG: + cb->had_pruneorskip = TRUE; + /* Fall through */ + case META_MARK: + case META_COMMIT_ARG: + VERB_ARG: + *code++ = verbops[(meta - META_MARK) >> 16]; + /* The length is in characters. */ + verbarglen = *(++pptr); + verbculen = 0; + tempcode = code++; + for (int i = 0; i < (int)verbarglen; i++) + { + meta = *(++pptr); +#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE + if (utf) mclength = PRIV(ord2utf)(meta, mcbuffer); else +#endif + { + mclength = 1; + mcbuffer[0] = meta; + } + if (lengthptr != NULL) *lengthptr += mclength; else + { + memcpy(code, mcbuffer, CU2BYTES(mclength)); + code += mclength; + verbculen += mclength; + } + } + + *tempcode = verbculen; /* Fill in the code unit length */ + *code++ = 0; /* Terminating zero */ + break; + + + /* ===================================================================*/ + /* Handle options change. The new setting must be passed back for use in + subsequent branches. Reset the greedy defaults and the case value for + firstcu and reqcu. */ + + case META_OPTIONS: + *optionsptr = options = *(++pptr); + greedy_default = ((options & PCRE2_UNGREEDY) != 0); + greedy_non_default = greedy_default ^ 1; + req_caseopt = ((options & PCRE2_CASELESS) != 0)? REQ_CASELESS : 0; + break; + + + /* ===================================================================*/ + /* Handle conditional subpatterns. The case of (?(Rdigits) is ambiguous + because it could be a numerical check on recursion, or a name check on a + group's being set. The pre-pass sets up META_COND_RNUMBER as a name so that + we can handle it either way. We first try for a name; if not found, process + the number. */ + + case META_COND_RNUMBER: /* (?(Rdigits) */ + case META_COND_NAME: /* (?(name) or (?'name') or ?(<name>) */ + case META_COND_RNAME: /* (?(R&name) - test for recursion */ + bravalue = OP_COND; + { + int count, index; + unsigned int i; + PCRE2_SPTR name; + named_group *ng = cb->named_groups; + uint32_t length = *(++pptr); + + GETPLUSOFFSET(offset, pptr); + name = cb->start_pattern + offset; + + /* In the first pass, the names generated in the pre-pass are available, + but the main name table has not yet been created. Scan the list of names + generated in the pre-pass in order to get a number and whether or not + this name is duplicated. If it is not duplicated, we can handle it as a + numerical group. */ + + for (i = 0; i < cb->names_found; i++, ng++) + { + if (length == ng->length && + PRIV(strncmp)(name, ng->name, length) == 0) + { + if (!ng->isdup) + { + code[1+LINK_SIZE] = (meta == META_COND_RNAME)? OP_RREF : OP_CREF; + PUT2(code, 2+LINK_SIZE, ng->number); + if (ng->number > cb->top_backref) cb->top_backref = ng->number; + skipunits = 1+IMM2_SIZE; + goto GROUP_PROCESS_NOTE_EMPTY; + } + break; /* Found a duplicated name */ + } + } + + /* If the name was not found we have a bad reference, unless we are + dealing with R<digits>, which is treated as a recursion test by number. + */ + + if (i >= cb->names_found) + { + groupnumber = 0; + if (meta == META_COND_RNUMBER) + { + for (i = 1; i < length; i++) + { + groupnumber = groupnumber * 10 + name[i] - CHAR_0; + if (groupnumber > MAX_GROUP_NUMBER) + { + *errorcodeptr = ERR61; + cb->erroroffset = offset + i; + return 0; + } + } + } + + if (meta != META_COND_RNUMBER || groupnumber > cb->bracount) + { + *errorcodeptr = ERR15; + cb->erroroffset = offset; + return 0; + } + + /* (?Rdigits) treated as a recursion reference by number. A value of + zero (which is the result of both (?R) and (?R0)) means "any", and is + translated into RREF_ANY (which is 0xffff). */ + + if (groupnumber == 0) groupnumber = RREF_ANY; + code[1+LINK_SIZE] = OP_RREF; + PUT2(code, 2+LINK_SIZE, groupnumber); + skipunits = 1+IMM2_SIZE; + goto GROUP_PROCESS_NOTE_EMPTY; + } + + /* A duplicated name was found. Note that if an R<digits> name is found + (META_COND_RNUMBER), it is a reference test, not a recursion test. */ + + code[1+LINK_SIZE] = (meta == META_COND_RNAME)? OP_RREF : OP_CREF; + + /* We have a duplicated name. In the compile pass we have to search the + main table in order to get the index and count values. */ + + count = 0; /* Values for first pass (avoids compiler warning) */ + index = 0; + if (lengthptr == NULL && !find_dupname_details(name, length, &index, + &count, errorcodeptr, cb)) return 0; + + /* Add one to the opcode to change CREF/RREF into DNCREF/DNRREF and + insert appropriate data values. */ + + code[1+LINK_SIZE]++; + skipunits = 1+2*IMM2_SIZE; + PUT2(code, 2+LINK_SIZE, index); + PUT2(code, 2+LINK_SIZE+IMM2_SIZE, count); + } + goto GROUP_PROCESS_NOTE_EMPTY; + + /* The DEFINE condition is always false. Its internal groups may never + be called, so matched_char must remain false, hence the jump to + GROUP_PROCESS rather than GROUP_PROCESS_NOTE_EMPTY. */ + + case META_COND_DEFINE: + bravalue = OP_COND; + GETPLUSOFFSET(offset, pptr); + code[1+LINK_SIZE] = OP_DEFINE; + skipunits = 1; + goto GROUP_PROCESS; + + /* Conditional test of a group's being set. */ + + case META_COND_NUMBER: + bravalue = OP_COND; + GETPLUSOFFSET(offset, pptr); + groupnumber = *(++pptr); + if (groupnumber > cb->bracount) + { + *errorcodeptr = ERR15; + cb->erroroffset = offset; + return 0; + } + if (groupnumber > cb->top_backref) cb->top_backref = groupnumber; + offset -= 2; /* Point at initial ( for too many branches error */ + code[1+LINK_SIZE] = OP_CREF; + skipunits = 1+IMM2_SIZE; + PUT2(code, 2+LINK_SIZE, groupnumber); + goto GROUP_PROCESS_NOTE_EMPTY; + + /* Test for the PCRE2 version. */ + + case META_COND_VERSION: + bravalue = OP_COND; + if (pptr[1] > 0) + code[1+LINK_SIZE] = ((PCRE2_MAJOR > pptr[2]) || + (PCRE2_MAJOR == pptr[2] && PCRE2_MINOR >= pptr[3]))? + OP_TRUE : OP_FALSE; + else + code[1+LINK_SIZE] = (PCRE2_MAJOR == pptr[2] && PCRE2_MINOR == pptr[3])? + OP_TRUE : OP_FALSE; + skipunits = 1; + pptr += 3; + goto GROUP_PROCESS_NOTE_EMPTY; + + /* The condition is an assertion, possibly preceded by a callout. */ + + case META_COND_ASSERT: + bravalue = OP_COND; + goto GROUP_PROCESS_NOTE_EMPTY; + + + /* ===================================================================*/ + /* Handle all kinds of nested bracketed groups. The non-capturing, + non-conditional cases are here; others come to GROUP_PROCESS via goto. */ + + case META_LOOKAHEAD: + bravalue = OP_ASSERT; + cb->assert_depth += 1; + goto GROUP_PROCESS; + + case META_LOOKAHEAD_NA: + bravalue = OP_ASSERT_NA; + cb->assert_depth += 1; + goto GROUP_PROCESS; + + /* Optimize (?!) to (*FAIL) unless it is quantified - which is a weird + thing to do, but Perl allows all assertions to be quantified, and when + they contain capturing parentheses there may be a potential use for + this feature. Not that that applies to a quantified (?!) but we allow + it for uniformity. */ + + case META_LOOKAHEADNOT: + if (pptr[1] == META_KET && + (pptr[2] < META_ASTERISK || pptr[2] > META_MINMAX_QUERY)) + { + *code++ = OP_FAIL; + pptr++; + } + else + { + bravalue = OP_ASSERT_NOT; + cb->assert_depth += 1; + goto GROUP_PROCESS; + } + break; + + case META_LOOKBEHIND: + bravalue = OP_ASSERTBACK; + cb->assert_depth += 1; + goto GROUP_PROCESS; + + case META_LOOKBEHINDNOT: + bravalue = OP_ASSERTBACK_NOT; + cb->assert_depth += 1; + goto GROUP_PROCESS; + + case META_LOOKBEHIND_NA: + bravalue = OP_ASSERTBACK_NA; + cb->assert_depth += 1; + goto GROUP_PROCESS; + + case META_ATOMIC: + bravalue = OP_ONCE; + goto GROUP_PROCESS_NOTE_EMPTY; + + case META_SCRIPT_RUN: + bravalue = OP_SCRIPT_RUN; + goto GROUP_PROCESS_NOTE_EMPTY; + + case META_NOCAPTURE: + bravalue = OP_BRA; + /* Fall through */ + + /* Process nested bracketed regex. The nesting depth is maintained for the + benefit of the stackguard function. The test for too deep nesting is now + done in parse_regex(). Assertion and DEFINE groups come to GROUP_PROCESS; + others come to GROUP_PROCESS_NOTE_EMPTY, to indicate that we need to take + note of whether or not they may match an empty string. */ + + GROUP_PROCESS_NOTE_EMPTY: + note_group_empty = TRUE; + + GROUP_PROCESS: + cb->parens_depth += 1; + *code = bravalue; + pptr++; + tempcode = code; + tempreqvary = cb->req_varyopt; /* Save value before group */ + length_prevgroup = 0; /* Initialize for pre-compile phase */ + + if ((group_return = + compile_regex( + options, /* The option state */ + &tempcode, /* Where to put code (updated) */ + &pptr, /* Input pointer (updated) */ + errorcodeptr, /* Where to put an error message */ + skipunits, /* Skip over bracket number */ + &subfirstcu, /* For possible first char */ + &subfirstcuflags, + &subreqcu, /* For possible last char */ + &subreqcuflags, + bcptr, /* Current branch chain */ + cb, /* Compile data block */ + (lengthptr == NULL)? NULL : /* Actual compile phase */ + &length_prevgroup /* Pre-compile phase */ + )) == 0) + return 0; /* Error */ + + cb->parens_depth -= 1; + + /* If that was a non-conditional significant group (not an assertion, not a + DEFINE) that matches at least one character, then the current item matches + a character. Conditionals are handled below. */ + + if (note_group_empty && bravalue != OP_COND && group_return > 0) + matched_char = TRUE; + + /* If we've just compiled an assertion, pop the assert depth. */ + + if (bravalue >= OP_ASSERT && bravalue <= OP_ASSERTBACK_NA) + cb->assert_depth -= 1; + + /* At the end of compiling, code is still pointing to the start of the + group, while tempcode has been updated to point past the end of the group. + The parsed pattern pointer (pptr) is on the closing META_KET. + + If this is a conditional bracket, check that there are no more than + two branches in the group, or just one if it's a DEFINE group. We do this + in the real compile phase, not in the pre-pass, where the whole group may + not be available. */ + + if (bravalue == OP_COND && lengthptr == NULL) + { + PCRE2_UCHAR *tc = code; + int condcount = 0; + + do { + condcount++; + tc += GET(tc,1); + } + while (*tc != OP_KET); + + /* A DEFINE group is never obeyed inline (the "condition" is always + false). It must have only one branch. Having checked this, change the + opcode to OP_FALSE. */ + + if (code[LINK_SIZE+1] == OP_DEFINE) + { + if (condcount > 1) + { + cb->erroroffset = offset; + *errorcodeptr = ERR54; + return 0; + } + code[LINK_SIZE+1] = OP_FALSE; + bravalue = OP_DEFINE; /* A flag to suppress char handling below */ + } + + /* A "normal" conditional group. If there is just one branch, we must not + make use of its firstcu or reqcu, because this is equivalent to an + empty second branch. Also, it may match an empty string. If there are two + branches, this item must match a character if the group must. */ + + else + { + if (condcount > 2) + { + cb->erroroffset = offset; + *errorcodeptr = ERR27; + return 0; + } + if (condcount == 1) subfirstcuflags = subreqcuflags = REQ_NONE; + else if (group_return > 0) matched_char = TRUE; + } + } + + /* In the pre-compile phase, update the length by the length of the group, + less the brackets at either end. Then reduce the compiled code to just a + set of non-capturing brackets so that it doesn't use much memory if it is + duplicated by a quantifier.*/ + + if (lengthptr != NULL) + { + if (OFLOW_MAX - *lengthptr < length_prevgroup - 2 - 2*LINK_SIZE) + { + *errorcodeptr = ERR20; + return 0; + } + *lengthptr += length_prevgroup - 2 - 2*LINK_SIZE; + code++; /* This already contains bravalue */ + PUTINC(code, 0, 1 + LINK_SIZE); + *code++ = OP_KET; + PUTINC(code, 0, 1 + LINK_SIZE); + break; /* No need to waste time with special character handling */ + } + + /* Otherwise update the main code pointer to the end of the group. */ + + code = tempcode; + + /* For a DEFINE group, required and first character settings are not + relevant. */ + + if (bravalue == OP_DEFINE) break; + + /* Handle updating of the required and first code units for other types of + group. Update for normal brackets of all kinds, and conditions with two + branches (see code above). If the bracket is followed by a quantifier with + zero repeat, we have to back off. Hence the definition of zeroreqcu and + zerofirstcu outside the main loop so that they can be accessed for the back + off. */ + + zeroreqcu = reqcu; + zeroreqcuflags = reqcuflags; + zerofirstcu = firstcu; + zerofirstcuflags = firstcuflags; + groupsetfirstcu = FALSE; + + if (bravalue >= OP_ONCE) /* Not an assertion */ + { + /* If we have not yet set a firstcu in this branch, take it from the + subpattern, remembering that it was set here so that a repeat of more + than one can replicate it as reqcu if necessary. If the subpattern has + no firstcu, set "none" for the whole branch. In both cases, a zero + repeat forces firstcu to "none". */ + + if (firstcuflags == REQ_UNSET && subfirstcuflags != REQ_UNSET) + { + if (subfirstcuflags < REQ_NONE) + { + firstcu = subfirstcu; + firstcuflags = subfirstcuflags; + groupsetfirstcu = TRUE; + } + else firstcuflags = REQ_NONE; + zerofirstcuflags = REQ_NONE; + } + + /* If firstcu was previously set, convert the subpattern's firstcu + into reqcu if there wasn't one, using the vary flag that was in + existence beforehand. */ + + else if (subfirstcuflags < REQ_NONE && subreqcuflags >= REQ_NONE) + { + subreqcu = subfirstcu; + subreqcuflags = subfirstcuflags | tempreqvary; + } + + /* If the subpattern set a required code unit (or set a first code unit + that isn't really the first code unit - see above), set it. */ + + if (subreqcuflags < REQ_NONE) + { + reqcu = subreqcu; + reqcuflags = subreqcuflags; + } + } + + /* For a forward assertion, we take the reqcu, if set, provided that the + group has also set a firstcu. This can be helpful if the pattern that + follows the assertion doesn't set a different char. For example, it's + useful for /(?=abcde).+/. We can't set firstcu for an assertion, however + because it leads to incorrect effect for patterns such as /(?=a)a.+/ when + the "real" "a" would then become a reqcu instead of a firstcu. This is + overcome by a scan at the end if there's no firstcu, looking for an + asserted first char. A similar effect for patterns like /(?=.*X)X$/ means + we must only take the reqcu when the group also set a firstcu. Otherwise, + in that example, 'X' ends up set for both. */ + + else if ((bravalue == OP_ASSERT || bravalue == OP_ASSERT_NA) && + subreqcuflags < REQ_NONE && subfirstcuflags < REQ_NONE) + { + reqcu = subreqcu; + reqcuflags = subreqcuflags; + } + + break; /* End of nested group handling */ + + + /* ===================================================================*/ + /* Handle named backreferences and recursions. */ + + case META_BACKREF_BYNAME: + case META_RECURSE_BYNAME: + { + int count, index; + PCRE2_SPTR name; + BOOL is_dupname = FALSE; + named_group *ng = cb->named_groups; + uint32_t length = *(++pptr); + + GETPLUSOFFSET(offset, pptr); + name = cb->start_pattern + offset; + + /* In the first pass, the names generated in the pre-pass are available, + but the main name table has not yet been created. Scan the list of names + generated in the pre-pass in order to get a number and whether or not + this name is duplicated. */ + + groupnumber = 0; + for (unsigned int i = 0; i < cb->names_found; i++, ng++) + { + if (length == ng->length && + PRIV(strncmp)(name, ng->name, length) == 0) + { + is_dupname = ng->isdup; + groupnumber = ng->number; + + /* For a recursion, that's all that is needed. We can now go to + the code that handles numerical recursion, applying it to the first + group with the given name. */ + + if (meta == META_RECURSE_BYNAME) + { + meta_arg = groupnumber; + goto HANDLE_NUMERICAL_RECURSION; + } + + /* For a back reference, update the back reference map and the + maximum back reference. */ + + cb->backref_map |= (groupnumber < 32)? (1u << groupnumber) : 1; + if (groupnumber > cb->top_backref) + cb->top_backref = groupnumber; + } + } + + /* If the name was not found we have a bad reference. */ + + if (groupnumber == 0) + { + *errorcodeptr = ERR15; + cb->erroroffset = offset; + return 0; + } + + /* If a back reference name is not duplicated, we can handle it as + a numerical reference. */ + + if (!is_dupname) + { + meta_arg = groupnumber; + goto HANDLE_SINGLE_REFERENCE; + } + + /* If a back reference name is duplicated, we generate a different + opcode to a numerical back reference. In the second pass we must + search for the index and count in the final name table. */ + + count = 0; /* Values for first pass (avoids compiler warning) */ + index = 0; + if (lengthptr == NULL && !find_dupname_details(name, length, &index, + &count, errorcodeptr, cb)) return 0; + + if (firstcuflags == REQ_UNSET) firstcuflags = REQ_NONE; + *code++ = ((options & PCRE2_CASELESS) != 0)? OP_DNREFI : OP_DNREF; + PUT2INC(code, 0, index); + PUT2INC(code, 0, count); + } + break; + + + /* ===================================================================*/ + /* Handle a numerical callout. */ + + case META_CALLOUT_NUMBER: + code[0] = OP_CALLOUT; + PUT(code, 1, pptr[1]); /* Offset to next pattern item */ + PUT(code, 1 + LINK_SIZE, pptr[2]); /* Length of next pattern item */ + code[1 + 2*LINK_SIZE] = pptr[3]; + pptr += 3; + code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[OP_CALLOUT]; + break; + + + /* ===================================================================*/ + /* Handle a callout with a string argument. In the pre-pass we just compute + the length without generating anything. The length in pptr[3] includes both + delimiters; in the actual compile only the first one is copied, but a + terminating zero is added. Any doubled delimiters within the string make + this an overestimate, but it is not worth bothering about. */ + + case META_CALLOUT_STRING: + if (lengthptr != NULL) + { + *lengthptr += pptr[3] + (1 + 4*LINK_SIZE); + pptr += 3; + SKIPOFFSET(pptr); + } + + /* In the real compile we can copy the string. The starting delimiter is + included so that the client can discover it if they want. We also pass the + start offset to help a script language give better error messages. */ + + else + { + PCRE2_SPTR pp; + uint32_t delimiter; + uint32_t length = pptr[3]; + PCRE2_UCHAR *callout_string = code + (1 + 4*LINK_SIZE); + + code[0] = OP_CALLOUT_STR; + PUT(code, 1, pptr[1]); /* Offset to next pattern item */ + PUT(code, 1 + LINK_SIZE, pptr[2]); /* Length of next pattern item */ + + pptr += 3; + GETPLUSOFFSET(offset, pptr); /* Offset to string in pattern */ + pp = cb->start_pattern + offset; + delimiter = *callout_string++ = *pp++; + if (delimiter == CHAR_LEFT_CURLY_BRACKET) + delimiter = CHAR_RIGHT_CURLY_BRACKET; + PUT(code, 1 + 3*LINK_SIZE, (int)(offset + 1)); /* One after delimiter */ + + /* The syntax of the pattern was checked in the parsing scan. The length + includes both delimiters, but we have passed the opening one just above, + so we reduce length before testing it. The test is for > 1 because we do + not want to copy the final delimiter. This also ensures that pp[1] is + accessible. */ + + while (--length > 1) + { + if (*pp == delimiter && pp[1] == delimiter) + { + *callout_string++ = delimiter; + pp += 2; + length--; + } + else *callout_string++ = *pp++; + } + *callout_string++ = CHAR_NUL; + + /* Set the length of the entire item, the advance to its end. */ + + PUT(code, 1 + 2*LINK_SIZE, (int)(callout_string - code)); + code = callout_string; + } + break; + + + /* ===================================================================*/ + /* Handle repetition. The different types are all sorted out in the parsing + pass. */ + + case META_MINMAX_PLUS: + case META_MINMAX_QUERY: + case META_MINMAX: + repeat_min = *(++pptr); + repeat_max = *(++pptr); + goto REPEAT; + + case META_ASTERISK: + case META_ASTERISK_PLUS: + case META_ASTERISK_QUERY: + repeat_min = 0; + repeat_max = REPEAT_UNLIMITED; + goto REPEAT; + + case META_PLUS: + case META_PLUS_PLUS: + case META_PLUS_QUERY: + repeat_min = 1; + repeat_max = REPEAT_UNLIMITED; + goto REPEAT; + + case META_QUERY: + case META_QUERY_PLUS: + case META_QUERY_QUERY: + repeat_min = 0; + repeat_max = 1; + + REPEAT: + if (previous_matched_char && repeat_min > 0) matched_char = TRUE; + + /* Remember whether this is a variable length repeat, and default to + single-char opcodes. */ + + reqvary = (repeat_min == repeat_max)? 0 : REQ_VARY; + op_type = 0; + + /* Adjust first and required code units for a zero repeat. */ + + if (repeat_min == 0) + { + firstcu = zerofirstcu; + firstcuflags = zerofirstcuflags; + reqcu = zeroreqcu; + reqcuflags = zeroreqcuflags; + } + + /* Note the greediness and possessiveness. */ + + switch (meta) + { + case META_MINMAX_PLUS: + case META_ASTERISK_PLUS: + case META_PLUS_PLUS: + case META_QUERY_PLUS: + repeat_type = 0; /* Force greedy */ + possessive_quantifier = TRUE; + break; + + case META_MINMAX_QUERY: + case META_ASTERISK_QUERY: + case META_PLUS_QUERY: + case META_QUERY_QUERY: + repeat_type = greedy_non_default; + possessive_quantifier = FALSE; + break; + + default: + repeat_type = greedy_default; + possessive_quantifier = FALSE; + break; + } + + /* Save start of previous item, in case we have to move it up in order to + insert something before it, and remember what it was. */ + + tempcode = previous; + op_previous = *previous; + + /* Now handle repetition for the different types of item. If the repeat + minimum and the repeat maximum are both 1, we can ignore the quantifier for + non-parenthesized items, as they have only one alternative. For anything in + parentheses, we must not ignore if {1} is possessive. */ + + switch (op_previous) + { + /* If previous was a character or negated character match, abolish the + item and generate a repeat item instead. If a char item has a minimum of + more than one, ensure that it is set in reqcu - it might not be if a + sequence such as x{3} is the first thing in a branch because the x will + have gone into firstcu instead. */ + + case OP_CHAR: + case OP_CHARI: + case OP_NOT: + case OP_NOTI: + if (repeat_max == 1 && repeat_min == 1) goto END_REPEAT; + op_type = chartypeoffset[op_previous - OP_CHAR]; + + /* Deal with UTF characters that take up more than one code unit. */ + +#ifdef MAYBE_UTF_MULTI + if (utf && NOT_FIRSTCU(code[-1])) + { + PCRE2_UCHAR *lastchar = code - 1; + BACKCHAR(lastchar); + mclength = (uint32_t)(code - lastchar); /* Length of UTF character */ + memcpy(mcbuffer, lastchar, CU2BYTES(mclength)); /* Save the char */ + } + else +#endif /* MAYBE_UTF_MULTI */ + + /* Handle the case of a single code unit - either with no UTF support, or + with UTF disabled, or for a single-code-unit UTF character. In the latter + case, for a repeated positive match, get the caseless flag for the + required code unit from the previous character, because a class like [Aa] + sets a caseless A but by now the req_caseopt flag has been reset. */ + + { + mcbuffer[0] = code[-1]; + mclength = 1; + if (op_previous <= OP_CHARI && repeat_min > 1) + { + reqcu = mcbuffer[0]; + reqcuflags = cb->req_varyopt; + if (op_previous == OP_CHARI) reqcuflags |= REQ_CASELESS; + } + } + goto OUTPUT_SINGLE_REPEAT; /* Code shared with single character types */ + + /* If previous was a character class or a back reference, we put the + repeat stuff after it, but just skip the item if the repeat was {0,0}. */ + +#ifdef SUPPORT_WIDE_CHARS + case OP_XCLASS: +#endif + case OP_CLASS: + case OP_NCLASS: + case OP_REF: + case OP_REFI: + case OP_DNREF: + case OP_DNREFI: + + if (repeat_max == 0) + { + code = previous; + goto END_REPEAT; + } + if (repeat_max == 1 && repeat_min == 1) goto END_REPEAT; + + if (repeat_min == 0 && repeat_max == REPEAT_UNLIMITED) + *code++ = OP_CRSTAR + repeat_type; + else if (repeat_min == 1 && repeat_max == REPEAT_UNLIMITED) + *code++ = OP_CRPLUS + repeat_type; + else if (repeat_min == 0 && repeat_max == 1) + *code++ = OP_CRQUERY + repeat_type; + else + { + *code++ = OP_CRRANGE + repeat_type; + PUT2INC(code, 0, repeat_min); + if (repeat_max == REPEAT_UNLIMITED) repeat_max = 0; /* 2-byte encoding for max */ + PUT2INC(code, 0, repeat_max); + } + break; + + /* If previous is OP_FAIL, it was generated by an empty class [] + (PCRE2_ALLOW_EMPTY_CLASS is set). The other ways in which OP_FAIL can be + generated, that is by (*FAIL) or (?!), disallow a quantifier at parse + time. We can just ignore this repeat. */ + + case OP_FAIL: + goto END_REPEAT; + + /* Prior to 10.30, repeated recursions were wrapped in OP_ONCE brackets + because pcre2_match() could not handle backtracking into recursively + called groups. Now that this backtracking is available, we no longer need + to do this. However, we still need to replicate recursions as we do for + groups so as to have independent backtracking points. We can replicate + for the minimum number of repeats directly. For optional repeats we now + wrap the recursion in OP_BRA brackets and make use of the bracket + repetition. */ + + case OP_RECURSE: + if (repeat_max == 1 && repeat_min == 1 && !possessive_quantifier) + goto END_REPEAT; + + /* Generate unwrapped repeats for a non-zero minimum, except when the + minimum is 1 and the maximum unlimited, because that can be handled with + OP_BRA terminated by OP_KETRMAX/MIN. When the maximum is equal to the + minimum, we just need to generate the appropriate additional copies. + Otherwise we need to generate one more, to simulate the situation when + the minimum is zero. */ + + if (repeat_min > 0 && (repeat_min != 1 || repeat_max != REPEAT_UNLIMITED)) + { + int replicate = repeat_min; + if (repeat_min == repeat_max) replicate--; + + /* In the pre-compile phase, we don't actually do the replication. We + just adjust the length as if we had. Do some paranoid checks for + potential integer overflow. The INT64_OR_DOUBLE type is a 64-bit + integer type when available, otherwise double. */ + + if (lengthptr != NULL) + { + PCRE2_SIZE delta = replicate*(1 + LINK_SIZE); + if ((INT64_OR_DOUBLE)replicate* + (INT64_OR_DOUBLE)(1 + LINK_SIZE) > + (INT64_OR_DOUBLE)INT_MAX || + OFLOW_MAX - *lengthptr < delta) + { + *errorcodeptr = ERR20; + return 0; + } + *lengthptr += delta; + } + + else for (int i = 0; i < replicate; i++) + { + memcpy(code, previous, CU2BYTES(1 + LINK_SIZE)); + previous = code; + code += 1 + LINK_SIZE; + } + + /* If the number of repeats is fixed, we are done. Otherwise, adjust + the counts and fall through. */ + + if (repeat_min == repeat_max) break; + if (repeat_max != REPEAT_UNLIMITED) repeat_max -= repeat_min; + repeat_min = 0; + } + + /* Wrap the recursion call in OP_BRA brackets. */ + + (void)memmove(previous + 1 + LINK_SIZE, previous, CU2BYTES(1 + LINK_SIZE)); + op_previous = *previous = OP_BRA; + PUT(previous, 1, 2 + 2*LINK_SIZE); + previous[2 + 2*LINK_SIZE] = OP_KET; + PUT(previous, 3 + 2*LINK_SIZE, 2 + 2*LINK_SIZE); + code += 2 + 2 * LINK_SIZE; + length_prevgroup = 3 + 3*LINK_SIZE; + group_return = -1; /* Set "may match empty string" */ + + /* Now treat as a repeated OP_BRA. */ + /* Fall through */ + + /* If previous was a bracket group, we may have to replicate it in + certain cases. Note that at this point we can encounter only the "basic" + bracket opcodes such as BRA and CBRA, as this is the place where they get + converted into the more special varieties such as BRAPOS and SBRA. + Originally, PCRE did not allow repetition of assertions, but now it does, + for Perl compatibility. */ + + case OP_ASSERT: + case OP_ASSERT_NOT: + case OP_ASSERT_NA: + case OP_ASSERTBACK: + case OP_ASSERTBACK_NOT: + case OP_ASSERTBACK_NA: + case OP_ONCE: + case OP_SCRIPT_RUN: + case OP_BRA: + case OP_CBRA: + case OP_COND: + { + int len = (int)(code - previous); + PCRE2_UCHAR *bralink = NULL; + PCRE2_UCHAR *brazeroptr = NULL; + + if (repeat_max == 1 && repeat_min == 1 && !possessive_quantifier) + goto END_REPEAT; + + /* Repeating a DEFINE group (or any group where the condition is always + FALSE and there is only one branch) is pointless, but Perl allows the + syntax, so we just ignore the repeat. */ + + if (op_previous == OP_COND && previous[LINK_SIZE+1] == OP_FALSE && + previous[GET(previous, 1)] != OP_ALT) + goto END_REPEAT; + + /* Perl allows all assertions to be quantified, and when they contain + capturing parentheses and/or are optional there are potential uses for + this feature. PCRE2 used to force the maximum quantifier to 1 on the + invalid grounds that further repetition was never useful. This was + always a bit pointless, since an assertion could be wrapped with a + repeated group to achieve the effect. General repetition is now + permitted, but if the maximum is unlimited it is set to one more than + the minimum. */ + + if (op_previous < OP_ONCE) /* Assertion */ + { + if (repeat_max == REPEAT_UNLIMITED) repeat_max = repeat_min + 1; + } + + /* The case of a zero minimum is special because of the need to stick + OP_BRAZERO in front of it, and because the group appears once in the + data, whereas in other cases it appears the minimum number of times. For + this reason, it is simplest to treat this case separately, as otherwise + the code gets far too messy. There are several special subcases when the + minimum is zero. */ + + if (repeat_min == 0) + { + /* If the maximum is also zero, we used to just omit the group from + the output altogether, like this: + + ** if (repeat_max == 0) + ** { + ** code = previous; + ** goto END_REPEAT; + ** } + + However, that fails when a group or a subgroup within it is + referenced as a subroutine from elsewhere in the pattern, so now we + stick in OP_SKIPZERO in front of it so that it is skipped on + execution. As we don't have a list of which groups are referenced, we + cannot do this selectively. + + If the maximum is 1 or unlimited, we just have to stick in the + BRAZERO and do no more at this point. */ + + if (repeat_max <= 1 || repeat_max == REPEAT_UNLIMITED) + { + (void)memmove(previous + 1, previous, CU2BYTES(len)); + code++; + if (repeat_max == 0) + { + *previous++ = OP_SKIPZERO; + goto END_REPEAT; + } + brazeroptr = previous; /* Save for possessive optimizing */ + *previous++ = OP_BRAZERO + repeat_type; + } + + /* If the maximum is greater than 1 and limited, we have to replicate + in a nested fashion, sticking OP_BRAZERO before each set of brackets. + The first one has to be handled carefully because it's the original + copy, which has to be moved up. The remainder can be handled by code + that is common with the non-zero minimum case below. We have to + adjust the value or repeat_max, since one less copy is required. */ + + else + { + int linkoffset; + (void)memmove(previous + 2 + LINK_SIZE, previous, CU2BYTES(len)); + code += 2 + LINK_SIZE; + *previous++ = OP_BRAZERO + repeat_type; + *previous++ = OP_BRA; + + /* We chain together the bracket link offset fields that have to be + filled in later when the ends of the brackets are reached. */ + + linkoffset = (bralink == NULL)? 0 : (int)(previous - bralink); + bralink = previous; + PUTINC(previous, 0, linkoffset); + } + + if (repeat_max != REPEAT_UNLIMITED) repeat_max--; + } + + /* If the minimum is greater than zero, replicate the group as many + times as necessary, and adjust the maximum to the number of subsequent + copies that we need. */ + + else + { + if (repeat_min > 1) + { + /* In the pre-compile phase, we don't actually do the replication. + We just adjust the length as if we had. Do some paranoid checks for + potential integer overflow. The INT64_OR_DOUBLE type is a 64-bit + integer type when available, otherwise double. */ + + if (lengthptr != NULL) + { + PCRE2_SIZE delta = (repeat_min - 1)*length_prevgroup; + if ((INT64_OR_DOUBLE)(repeat_min - 1)* + (INT64_OR_DOUBLE)length_prevgroup > + (INT64_OR_DOUBLE)INT_MAX || + OFLOW_MAX - *lengthptr < delta) + { + *errorcodeptr = ERR20; + return 0; + } + *lengthptr += delta; + } + + /* This is compiling for real. If there is a set first code unit + for the group, and we have not yet set a "required code unit", set + it. */ + + else + { + if (groupsetfirstcu && reqcuflags >= REQ_NONE) + { + reqcu = firstcu; + reqcuflags = firstcuflags; + } + for (uint32_t i = 1; i < repeat_min; i++) + { + memcpy(code, previous, CU2BYTES(len)); + code += len; + } + } + } + + if (repeat_max != REPEAT_UNLIMITED) repeat_max -= repeat_min; + } + + /* This code is common to both the zero and non-zero minimum cases. If + the maximum is limited, it replicates the group in a nested fashion, + remembering the bracket starts on a stack. In the case of a zero + minimum, the first one was set up above. In all cases the repeat_max + now specifies the number of additional copies needed. Again, we must + remember to replicate entries on the forward reference list. */ + + if (repeat_max != REPEAT_UNLIMITED) + { + /* In the pre-compile phase, we don't actually do the replication. We + just adjust the length as if we had. For each repetition we must add + 1 to the length for BRAZERO and for all but the last repetition we + must add 2 + 2*LINKSIZE to allow for the nesting that occurs. Do some + paranoid checks to avoid integer overflow. The INT64_OR_DOUBLE type + is a 64-bit integer type when available, otherwise double. */ + + if (lengthptr != NULL && repeat_max > 0) + { + PCRE2_SIZE delta = repeat_max*(length_prevgroup + 1 + 2 + 2*LINK_SIZE) - + 2 - 2*LINK_SIZE; /* Last one doesn't nest */ + if ((INT64_OR_DOUBLE)repeat_max * + (INT64_OR_DOUBLE)(length_prevgroup + 1 + 2 + 2*LINK_SIZE) + > (INT64_OR_DOUBLE)INT_MAX || + OFLOW_MAX - *lengthptr < delta) + { + *errorcodeptr = ERR20; + return 0; + } + *lengthptr += delta; + } + + /* This is compiling for real */ + + else for (uint32_t i = repeat_max; i >= 1; i--) + { + *code++ = OP_BRAZERO + repeat_type; + + /* All but the final copy start a new nesting, maintaining the + chain of brackets outstanding. */ + + if (i != 1) + { + int linkoffset; + *code++ = OP_BRA; + linkoffset = (bralink == NULL)? 0 : (int)(code - bralink); + bralink = code; + PUTINC(code, 0, linkoffset); + } + + memcpy(code, previous, CU2BYTES(len)); + code += len; + } + + /* Now chain through the pending brackets, and fill in their length + fields (which are holding the chain links pro tem). */ + + while (bralink != NULL) + { + int oldlinkoffset; + int linkoffset = (int)(code - bralink + 1); + PCRE2_UCHAR *bra = code - linkoffset; + oldlinkoffset = GET(bra, 1); + bralink = (oldlinkoffset == 0)? NULL : bralink - oldlinkoffset; + *code++ = OP_KET; + PUTINC(code, 0, linkoffset); + PUT(bra, 1, linkoffset); + } + } + + /* If the maximum is unlimited, set a repeater in the final copy. For + SCRIPT_RUN and ONCE brackets, that's all we need to do. However, + possessively repeated ONCE brackets can be converted into non-capturing + brackets, as the behaviour of (?:xx)++ is the same as (?>xx)++ and this + saves having to deal with possessive ONCEs specially. + + Otherwise, when we are doing the actual compile phase, check to see + whether this group is one that could match an empty string. If so, + convert the initial operator to the S form (e.g. OP_BRA -> OP_SBRA) so + that runtime checking can be done. [This check is also applied to ONCE + and SCRIPT_RUN groups at runtime, but in a different way.] + + Then, if the quantifier was possessive and the bracket is not a + conditional, we convert the BRA code to the POS form, and the KET code + to KETRPOS. (It turns out to be convenient at runtime to detect this + kind of subpattern at both the start and at the end.) The use of + special opcodes makes it possible to reduce greatly the stack usage in + pcre2_match(). If the group is preceded by OP_BRAZERO, convert this to + OP_BRAPOSZERO. + + Then, if the minimum number of matches is 1 or 0, cancel the possessive + flag so that the default action below, of wrapping everything inside + atomic brackets, does not happen. When the minimum is greater than 1, + there will be earlier copies of the group, and so we still have to wrap + the whole thing. */ + + else + { + PCRE2_UCHAR *ketcode = code - 1 - LINK_SIZE; + PCRE2_UCHAR *bracode = ketcode - GET(ketcode, 1); + + /* Convert possessive ONCE brackets to non-capturing */ + + if (*bracode == OP_ONCE && possessive_quantifier) *bracode = OP_BRA; + + /* For non-possessive ONCE and for SCRIPT_RUN brackets, all we need + to do is to set the KET. */ + + if (*bracode == OP_ONCE || *bracode == OP_SCRIPT_RUN) + *ketcode = OP_KETRMAX + repeat_type; + + /* Handle non-SCRIPT_RUN and non-ONCE brackets and possessive ONCEs + (which have been converted to non-capturing above). */ + + else + { + /* In the compile phase, adjust the opcode if the group can match + an empty string. For a conditional group with only one branch, the + value of group_return will not show "could be empty", so we must + check that separately. */ + + if (lengthptr == NULL) + { + if (group_return < 0) *bracode += OP_SBRA - OP_BRA; + if (*bracode == OP_COND && bracode[GET(bracode,1)] != OP_ALT) + *bracode = OP_SCOND; + } + + /* Handle possessive quantifiers. */ + + if (possessive_quantifier) + { + /* For COND brackets, we wrap the whole thing in a possessively + repeated non-capturing bracket, because we have not invented POS + versions of the COND opcodes. */ + + if (*bracode == OP_COND || *bracode == OP_SCOND) + { + int nlen = (int)(code - bracode); + (void)memmove(bracode + 1 + LINK_SIZE, bracode, CU2BYTES(nlen)); + code += 1 + LINK_SIZE; + nlen += 1 + LINK_SIZE; + *bracode = (*bracode == OP_COND)? OP_BRAPOS : OP_SBRAPOS; + *code++ = OP_KETRPOS; + PUTINC(code, 0, nlen); + PUT(bracode, 1, nlen); + } + + /* For non-COND brackets, we modify the BRA code and use KETRPOS. */ + + else + { + *bracode += 1; /* Switch to xxxPOS opcodes */ + *ketcode = OP_KETRPOS; + } + + /* If the minimum is zero, mark it as possessive, then unset the + possessive flag when the minimum is 0 or 1. */ + + if (brazeroptr != NULL) *brazeroptr = OP_BRAPOSZERO; + if (repeat_min < 2) possessive_quantifier = FALSE; + } + + /* Non-possessive quantifier */ + + else *ketcode = OP_KETRMAX + repeat_type; + } + } + } + break; + + /* If previous was a character type match (\d or similar), abolish it and + create a suitable repeat item. The code is shared with single-character + repeats by setting op_type to add a suitable offset into repeat_type. + Note the the Unicode property types will be present only when + SUPPORT_UNICODE is defined, but we don't wrap the little bits of code + here because it just makes it horribly messy. */ + + default: + if (op_previous >= OP_EODN) /* Not a character type - internal error */ + { + *errorcodeptr = ERR10; + return 0; + } + else + { + int prop_type, prop_value; + PCRE2_UCHAR *oldcode; + + if (repeat_max == 1 && repeat_min == 1) goto END_REPEAT; + + op_type = OP_TYPESTAR - OP_STAR; /* Use type opcodes */ + mclength = 0; /* Not a character */ + + if (op_previous == OP_PROP || op_previous == OP_NOTPROP) + { + prop_type = previous[1]; + prop_value = previous[2]; + } + else + { + /* Come here from just above with a character in mcbuffer/mclength. */ + OUTPUT_SINGLE_REPEAT: + prop_type = prop_value = -1; + } + + /* At this point, if prop_type == prop_value == -1 we either have a + character in mcbuffer when mclength is greater than zero, or we have + mclength zero, in which case there is a non-property character type in + op_previous. If prop_type/value are not negative, we have a property + character type in op_previous. */ + + oldcode = code; /* Save where we were */ + code = previous; /* Usually overwrite previous item */ + + /* If the maximum is zero then the minimum must also be zero; Perl allows + this case, so we do too - by simply omitting the item altogether. */ + + if (repeat_max == 0) goto END_REPEAT; + + /* Combine the op_type with the repeat_type */ + + repeat_type += op_type; + + /* A minimum of zero is handled either as the special case * or ?, or as + an UPTO, with the maximum given. */ + + if (repeat_min == 0) + { + if (repeat_max == REPEAT_UNLIMITED) *code++ = OP_STAR + repeat_type; + else if (repeat_max == 1) *code++ = OP_QUERY + repeat_type; + else + { + *code++ = OP_UPTO + repeat_type; + PUT2INC(code, 0, repeat_max); + } + } + + /* A repeat minimum of 1 is optimized into some special cases. If the + maximum is unlimited, we use OP_PLUS. Otherwise, the original item is + left in place and, if the maximum is greater than 1, we use OP_UPTO with + one less than the maximum. */ + + else if (repeat_min == 1) + { + if (repeat_max == REPEAT_UNLIMITED) + *code++ = OP_PLUS + repeat_type; + else + { + code = oldcode; /* Leave previous item in place */ + if (repeat_max == 1) goto END_REPEAT; + *code++ = OP_UPTO + repeat_type; + PUT2INC(code, 0, repeat_max - 1); + } + } + + /* The case {n,n} is just an EXACT, while the general case {n,m} is + handled as an EXACT followed by an UPTO or STAR or QUERY. */ + + else + { + *code++ = OP_EXACT + op_type; /* NB EXACT doesn't have repeat_type */ + PUT2INC(code, 0, repeat_min); + + /* Unless repeat_max equals repeat_min, fill in the data for EXACT, + and then generate the second opcode. For a repeated Unicode property + match, there are two extra values that define the required property, + and mclength is set zero to indicate this. */ + + if (repeat_max != repeat_min) + { + if (mclength > 0) + { + memcpy(code, mcbuffer, CU2BYTES(mclength)); + code += mclength; + } + else + { + *code++ = op_previous; + if (prop_type >= 0) + { + *code++ = prop_type; + *code++ = prop_value; + } + } + + /* Now set up the following opcode */ + + if (repeat_max == REPEAT_UNLIMITED) + *code++ = OP_STAR + repeat_type; + else + { + repeat_max -= repeat_min; + if (repeat_max == 1) + { + *code++ = OP_QUERY + repeat_type; + } + else + { + *code++ = OP_UPTO + repeat_type; + PUT2INC(code, 0, repeat_max); + } + } + } + } + + /* Fill in the character or character type for the final opcode. */ + + if (mclength > 0) + { + memcpy(code, mcbuffer, CU2BYTES(mclength)); + code += mclength; + } + else + { + *code++ = op_previous; + if (prop_type >= 0) + { + *code++ = prop_type; + *code++ = prop_value; + } + } + } + break; + } /* End of switch on different op_previous values */ + + + /* If the character following a repeat is '+', possessive_quantifier is + TRUE. For some opcodes, there are special alternative opcodes for this + case. For anything else, we wrap the entire repeated item inside OP_ONCE + brackets. Logically, the '+' notation is just syntactic sugar, taken from + Sun's Java package, but the special opcodes can optimize it. + + Some (but not all) possessively repeated subpatterns have already been + completely handled in the code just above. For them, possessive_quantifier + is always FALSE at this stage. Note that the repeated item starts at + tempcode, not at previous, which might be the first part of a string whose + (former) last char we repeated. */ + + if (possessive_quantifier) + { + int len; + + /* Possessifying an EXACT quantifier has no effect, so we can ignore it. + However, QUERY, STAR, or UPTO may follow (for quantifiers such as {5,6}, + {5,}, or {5,10}). We skip over an EXACT item; if the length of what + remains is greater than zero, there's a further opcode that can be + handled. If not, do nothing, leaving the EXACT alone. */ + + switch(*tempcode) + { + case OP_TYPEEXACT: + tempcode += PRIV(OP_lengths)[*tempcode] + + ((tempcode[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_PROP + || tempcode[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_NOTPROP)? 2 : 0); + break; + + /* CHAR opcodes are used for exacts whose count is 1. */ + + case OP_CHAR: + case OP_CHARI: + case OP_NOT: + case OP_NOTI: + case OP_EXACT: + case OP_EXACTI: + case OP_NOTEXACT: + case OP_NOTEXACTI: + tempcode += PRIV(OP_lengths)[*tempcode]; +#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE + if (utf && HAS_EXTRALEN(tempcode[-1])) + tempcode += GET_EXTRALEN(tempcode[-1]); +#endif + break; + + /* For the class opcodes, the repeat operator appears at the end; + adjust tempcode to point to it. */ + + case OP_CLASS: + case OP_NCLASS: + tempcode += 1 + 32/sizeof(PCRE2_UCHAR); + break; + +#ifdef SUPPORT_WIDE_CHARS + case OP_XCLASS: + tempcode += GET(tempcode, 1); + break; +#endif + } + + /* If tempcode is equal to code (which points to the end of the repeated + item), it means we have skipped an EXACT item but there is no following + QUERY, STAR, or UPTO; the value of len will be 0, and we do nothing. In + all other cases, tempcode will be pointing to the repeat opcode, and will + be less than code, so the value of len will be greater than 0. */ + + len = (int)(code - tempcode); + if (len > 0) + { + unsigned int repcode = *tempcode; + + /* There is a table for possessifying opcodes, all of which are less + than OP_CALLOUT. A zero entry means there is no possessified version. + */ + + if (repcode < OP_CALLOUT && opcode_possessify[repcode] > 0) + *tempcode = opcode_possessify[repcode]; + + /* For opcode without a special possessified version, wrap the item in + ONCE brackets. */ + + else + { + (void)memmove(tempcode + 1 + LINK_SIZE, tempcode, CU2BYTES(len)); + code += 1 + LINK_SIZE; + len += 1 + LINK_SIZE; + tempcode[0] = OP_ONCE; + *code++ = OP_KET; + PUTINC(code, 0, len); + PUT(tempcode, 1, len); + } + } + } + + /* We set the "follows varying string" flag for subsequently encountered + reqcus if it isn't already set and we have just passed a varying length + item. */ + + END_REPEAT: + cb->req_varyopt |= reqvary; + break; + + + /* ===================================================================*/ + /* Handle a 32-bit data character with a value greater than META_END. */ + + case META_BIGVALUE: + pptr++; + goto NORMAL_CHAR; + + + /* ===============================================================*/ + /* Handle a back reference by number, which is the meta argument. The + pattern offsets for back references to group numbers less than 10 are held + in a special vector, to avoid using more than two parsed pattern elements + in 64-bit environments. We only need the offset to the first occurrence, + because if that doesn't fail, subsequent ones will also be OK. */ + + case META_BACKREF: + if (meta_arg < 10) offset = cb->small_ref_offset[meta_arg]; + else GETPLUSOFFSET(offset, pptr); + + if (meta_arg > cb->bracount) + { + cb->erroroffset = offset; + *errorcodeptr = ERR15; /* Non-existent subpattern */ + return 0; + } + + /* Come here from named backref handling when the reference is to a + single group (that is, not to a duplicated name). The back reference + data will have already been updated. We must disable firstcu if not + set, to cope with cases like (?=(\w+))\1: which would otherwise set ':' + later. */ + + HANDLE_SINGLE_REFERENCE: + if (firstcuflags == REQ_UNSET) zerofirstcuflags = firstcuflags = REQ_NONE; + *code++ = ((options & PCRE2_CASELESS) != 0)? OP_REFI : OP_REF; + PUT2INC(code, 0, meta_arg); + + /* Update the map of back references, and keep the highest one. We + could do this in parse_regex() for numerical back references, but not + for named back references, because we don't know the numbers to which + named back references refer. So we do it all in this function. */ + + cb->backref_map |= (meta_arg < 32)? (1u << meta_arg) : 1; + if (meta_arg > cb->top_backref) cb->top_backref = meta_arg; + break; + + + /* ===============================================================*/ + /* Handle recursion by inserting the number of the called group (which is + the meta argument) after OP_RECURSE. At the end of compiling the pattern is + scanned and these numbers are replaced by offsets within the pattern. It is + done like this to avoid problems with forward references and adjusting + offsets when groups are duplicated and moved (as discovered in previous + implementations). Note that a recursion does not have a set first + character. */ + + case META_RECURSE: + GETPLUSOFFSET(offset, pptr); + if (meta_arg > cb->bracount) + { + cb->erroroffset = offset; + *errorcodeptr = ERR15; /* Non-existent subpattern */ + return 0; + } + HANDLE_NUMERICAL_RECURSION: + *code = OP_RECURSE; + PUT(code, 1, meta_arg); + code += 1 + LINK_SIZE; + groupsetfirstcu = FALSE; + cb->had_recurse = TRUE; + if (firstcuflags == REQ_UNSET) firstcuflags = REQ_NONE; + zerofirstcu = firstcu; + zerofirstcuflags = firstcuflags; + break; + + + /* ===============================================================*/ + /* Handle capturing parentheses; the number is the meta argument. */ + + case META_CAPTURE: + bravalue = OP_CBRA; + skipunits = IMM2_SIZE; + PUT2(code, 1+LINK_SIZE, meta_arg); + cb->lastcapture = meta_arg; + goto GROUP_PROCESS_NOTE_EMPTY; + + + /* ===============================================================*/ + /* Handle escape sequence items. For ones like \d, the ESC_values are + arranged to be the same as the corresponding OP_values in the default case + when PCRE2_UCP is not set (which is the only case in which they will appear + here). + + Note: \Q and \E are never seen here, as they were dealt with in + parse_pattern(). Neither are numerical back references or recursions, which + were turned into META_BACKREF or META_RECURSE items, respectively. \k and + \g, when followed by names, are turned into META_BACKREF_BYNAME or + META_RECURSE_BYNAME. */ + + case META_ESCAPE: + + /* We can test for escape sequences that consume a character because their + values lie between ESC_b and ESC_Z; this may have to change if any new ones + are ever created. For these sequences, we disable the setting of a first + character if it hasn't already been set. */ + + if (meta_arg > ESC_b && meta_arg < ESC_Z) + { + matched_char = TRUE; + if (firstcuflags == REQ_UNSET) firstcuflags = REQ_NONE; + } + + /* Set values to reset to if this is followed by a zero repeat. */ + + zerofirstcu = firstcu; + zerofirstcuflags = firstcuflags; + zeroreqcu = reqcu; + zeroreqcuflags = reqcuflags; + + /* If Unicode is not supported, \P and \p are not allowed and are + faulted at parse time, so will never appear here. */ + +#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE + if (meta_arg == ESC_P || meta_arg == ESC_p) + { + uint32_t ptype = *(++pptr) >> 16; + uint32_t pdata = *pptr & 0xffff; + + /* The special case of \p{Any} is compiled to OP_ALLANY so as to benefit + from the auto-anchoring code. */ + + if (meta_arg == ESC_p && ptype == PT_ANY) + { + *code++ = OP_ALLANY; + } + else + { + *code++ = (meta_arg == ESC_p)? OP_PROP : OP_NOTPROP; + *code++ = ptype; + *code++ = pdata; + } + break; /* End META_ESCAPE */ + } +#endif + + /* \K is forbidden in lookarounds since 10.38 because that's what Perl has + done. However, there's an option, in case anyone was relying on it. */ + + if (cb->assert_depth > 0 && meta_arg == ESC_K && + (cb->cx->extra_options & PCRE2_EXTRA_ALLOW_LOOKAROUND_BSK) == 0) + { + *errorcodeptr = ERR99; + return 0; + } + + /* For the rest (including \X when Unicode is supported - if not it's + faulted at parse time), the OP value is the escape value when PCRE2_UCP is + not set; if it is set, these escapes do not show up here because they are + converted into Unicode property tests in parse_regex(). Note that \b and \B + do a one-character lookbehind, and \A also behaves as if it does. */ + + if (meta_arg == ESC_C) cb->external_flags |= PCRE2_HASBKC; /* Record */ + if ((meta_arg == ESC_b || meta_arg == ESC_B || meta_arg == ESC_A) && + cb->max_lookbehind == 0) + cb->max_lookbehind = 1; + + /* In non-UTF mode, and for both 32-bit modes, we turn \C into OP_ALLANY + instead of OP_ANYBYTE so that it works in DFA mode and in lookbehinds. */ + +#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 32 + *code++ = (meta_arg == ESC_C)? OP_ALLANY : meta_arg; +#else + *code++ = (!utf && meta_arg == ESC_C)? OP_ALLANY : meta_arg; +#endif + break; /* End META_ESCAPE */ + + + /* ===================================================================*/ + /* Handle an unrecognized meta value. A parsed pattern value less than + META_END is a literal. Otherwise we have a problem. */ + + default: + if (meta >= META_END) + { +#ifdef DEBUG_SHOW_PARSED + fprintf(stderr, "** Unrecognized parsed pattern item 0x%.8x\n", *pptr); +#endif + *errorcodeptr = ERR89; /* Internal error - unrecognized. */ + return 0; + } + + /* Handle a literal character. We come here by goto in the case of a + 32-bit, non-UTF character whose value is greater than META_END. */ + + NORMAL_CHAR: + meta = *pptr; /* Get the full 32 bits */ + NORMAL_CHAR_SET: /* Character is already in meta */ + matched_char = TRUE; + + /* For caseless UTF or UCP mode, check whether this character has more than + one other case. If so, generate a special OP_PROP item instead of OP_CHARI. + */ + +#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE + if ((utf||ucp) && (options & PCRE2_CASELESS) != 0) + { + uint32_t caseset = UCD_CASESET(meta); + if (caseset != 0) + { + *code++ = OP_PROP; + *code++ = PT_CLIST; + *code++ = caseset; + if (firstcuflags == REQ_UNSET) + firstcuflags = zerofirstcuflags = REQ_NONE; + break; /* End handling this meta item */ + } + } +#endif + + /* Caseful matches, or caseless and not one of the multicase characters. We + come here by goto in the case of a positive class that contains only + case-partners of a character with just two cases; matched_char has already + been set TRUE and options fudged if necessary. */ + + CLASS_CASELESS_CHAR: + + /* Get the character's code units into mcbuffer, with the length in + mclength. When not in UTF mode, the length is always 1. */ + +#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE + if (utf) mclength = PRIV(ord2utf)(meta, mcbuffer); else +#endif + { + mclength = 1; + mcbuffer[0] = meta; + } + + /* Generate the appropriate code */ + + *code++ = ((options & PCRE2_CASELESS) != 0)? OP_CHARI : OP_CHAR; + memcpy(code, mcbuffer, CU2BYTES(mclength)); + code += mclength; + + /* Remember if \r or \n were seen */ + + if (mcbuffer[0] == CHAR_CR || mcbuffer[0] == CHAR_NL) + cb->external_flags |= PCRE2_HASCRORLF; + + /* Set the first and required code units appropriately. If no previous + first code unit, set it from this character, but revert to none on a zero + repeat. Otherwise, leave the firstcu value alone, and don't change it on + a zero repeat. */ + + if (firstcuflags == REQ_UNSET) + { + zerofirstcuflags = REQ_NONE; + zeroreqcu = reqcu; + zeroreqcuflags = reqcuflags; + + /* If the character is more than one code unit long, we can set a single + firstcu only if it is not to be matched caselessly. Multiple possible + starting code units may be picked up later in the studying code. */ + + if (mclength == 1 || req_caseopt == 0) + { + firstcu = mcbuffer[0]; + firstcuflags = req_caseopt; + if (mclength != 1) + { + reqcu = code[-1]; + reqcuflags = cb->req_varyopt; + } + } + else firstcuflags = reqcuflags = REQ_NONE; + } + + /* firstcu was previously set; we can set reqcu only if the length is + 1 or the matching is caseful. */ + + else + { + zerofirstcu = firstcu; + zerofirstcuflags = firstcuflags; + zeroreqcu = reqcu; + zeroreqcuflags = reqcuflags; + if (mclength == 1 || req_caseopt == 0) + { + reqcu = code[-1]; + reqcuflags = req_caseopt | cb->req_varyopt; + } + } + + /* If caselessness was temporarily instated, reset it. */ + + if (reset_caseful) + { + options &= ~PCRE2_CASELESS; + req_caseopt = 0; + reset_caseful = FALSE; + } + + break; /* End literal character handling */ + } /* End of big switch */ + } /* End of big loop */ + +/* Control never reaches here. */ +} + + + +/************************************************* +* Compile regex: a sequence of alternatives * +*************************************************/ + +/* On entry, pptr is pointing past the bracket meta, but on return it points to +the closing bracket or META_END. The code variable is pointing at the code unit +into which the BRA operator has been stored. This function is used during the +pre-compile phase when we are trying to find out the amount of memory needed, +as well as during the real compile phase. The value of lengthptr distinguishes +the two phases. + +Arguments: + options option bits, including any changes for this subpattern + codeptr -> the address of the current code pointer + pptrptr -> the address of the current parsed pattern pointer + errorcodeptr -> pointer to error code variable + skipunits skip this many code units at start (for brackets and OP_COND) + firstcuptr place to put the first required code unit + firstcuflagsptr place to put the first code unit flags + reqcuptr place to put the last required code unit + reqcuflagsptr place to put the last required code unit flags + bcptr pointer to the chain of currently open branches + cb points to the data block with tables pointers etc. + lengthptr NULL during the real compile phase + points to length accumulator during pre-compile phase + +Returns: 0 There has been an error + +1 Success, this group must match at least one character + -1 Success, this group may match an empty string +*/ + +static int +compile_regex(uint32_t options, PCRE2_UCHAR **codeptr, uint32_t **pptrptr, + int *errorcodeptr, uint32_t skipunits, uint32_t *firstcuptr, + uint32_t *firstcuflagsptr, uint32_t *reqcuptr, uint32_t *reqcuflagsptr, + branch_chain *bcptr, compile_block *cb, PCRE2_SIZE *lengthptr) +{ +PCRE2_UCHAR *code = *codeptr; +PCRE2_UCHAR *last_branch = code; +PCRE2_UCHAR *start_bracket = code; +BOOL lookbehind; +open_capitem capitem; +int capnumber = 0; +int okreturn = 1; +uint32_t *pptr = *pptrptr; +uint32_t firstcu, reqcu; +uint32_t lookbehindlength; +uint32_t firstcuflags, reqcuflags; +uint32_t branchfirstcu, branchreqcu; +uint32_t branchfirstcuflags, branchreqcuflags; +PCRE2_SIZE length; +branch_chain bc; + +/* If set, call the external function that checks for stack availability. */ + +if (cb->cx->stack_guard != NULL && + cb->cx->stack_guard(cb->parens_depth, cb->cx->stack_guard_data)) + { + *errorcodeptr= ERR33; + return 0; + } + +/* Miscellaneous initialization */ + +bc.outer = bcptr; +bc.current_branch = code; + +firstcu = reqcu = 0; +firstcuflags = reqcuflags = REQ_UNSET; + +/* Accumulate the length for use in the pre-compile phase. Start with the +length of the BRA and KET and any extra code units that are required at the +beginning. We accumulate in a local variable to save frequent testing of +lengthptr for NULL. We cannot do this by looking at the value of 'code' at the +start and end of each alternative, because compiled items are discarded during +the pre-compile phase so that the workspace is not exceeded. */ + +length = 2 + 2*LINK_SIZE + skipunits; + +/* Remember if this is a lookbehind assertion, and if it is, save its length +and skip over the pattern offset. */ + +lookbehind = *code == OP_ASSERTBACK || + *code == OP_ASSERTBACK_NOT || + *code == OP_ASSERTBACK_NA; + +if (lookbehind) + { + lookbehindlength = META_DATA(pptr[-1]); + pptr += SIZEOFFSET; + } +else lookbehindlength = 0; + +/* If this is a capturing subpattern, add to the chain of open capturing items +so that we can detect them if (*ACCEPT) is encountered. Note that only OP_CBRA +need be tested here; changing this opcode to one of its variants, e.g. +OP_SCBRAPOS, happens later, after the group has been compiled. */ + +if (*code == OP_CBRA) + { + capnumber = GET2(code, 1 + LINK_SIZE); + capitem.number = capnumber; + capitem.next = cb->open_caps; + capitem.assert_depth = cb->assert_depth; + cb->open_caps = &capitem; + } + +/* Offset is set zero to mark that this bracket is still open */ + +PUT(code, 1, 0); +code += 1 + LINK_SIZE + skipunits; + +/* Loop for each alternative branch */ + +for (;;) + { + int branch_return; + + /* Insert OP_REVERSE if this is as lookbehind assertion. */ + + if (lookbehind && lookbehindlength > 0) + { + *code++ = OP_REVERSE; + PUTINC(code, 0, lookbehindlength); + length += 1 + LINK_SIZE; + } + + /* Now compile the branch; in the pre-compile phase its length gets added + into the length. */ + + if ((branch_return = + compile_branch(&options, &code, &pptr, errorcodeptr, &branchfirstcu, + &branchfirstcuflags, &branchreqcu, &branchreqcuflags, &bc, + cb, (lengthptr == NULL)? NULL : &length)) == 0) + return 0; + + /* If a branch can match an empty string, so can the whole group. */ + + if (branch_return < 0) okreturn = -1; + + /* In the real compile phase, there is some post-processing to be done. */ + + if (lengthptr == NULL) + { + /* If this is the first branch, the firstcu and reqcu values for the + branch become the values for the regex. */ + + if (*last_branch != OP_ALT) + { + firstcu = branchfirstcu; + firstcuflags = branchfirstcuflags; + reqcu = branchreqcu; + reqcuflags = branchreqcuflags; + } + + /* If this is not the first branch, the first char and reqcu have to + match the values from all the previous branches, except that if the + previous value for reqcu didn't have REQ_VARY set, it can still match, + and we set REQ_VARY for the group from this branch's value. */ + + else + { + /* If we previously had a firstcu, but it doesn't match the new branch, + we have to abandon the firstcu for the regex, but if there was + previously no reqcu, it takes on the value of the old firstcu. */ + + if (firstcuflags != branchfirstcuflags || firstcu != branchfirstcu) + { + if (firstcuflags < REQ_NONE) + { + if (reqcuflags >= REQ_NONE) + { + reqcu = firstcu; + reqcuflags = firstcuflags; + } + } + firstcuflags = REQ_NONE; + } + + /* If we (now or from before) have no firstcu, a firstcu from the + branch becomes a reqcu if there isn't a branch reqcu. */ + + if (firstcuflags >= REQ_NONE && branchfirstcuflags < REQ_NONE && + branchreqcuflags >= REQ_NONE) + { + branchreqcu = branchfirstcu; + branchreqcuflags = branchfirstcuflags; + } + + /* Now ensure that the reqcus match */ + + if (((reqcuflags & ~REQ_VARY) != (branchreqcuflags & ~REQ_VARY)) || + reqcu != branchreqcu) + reqcuflags = REQ_NONE; + else + { + reqcu = branchreqcu; + reqcuflags |= branchreqcuflags; /* To "or" REQ_VARY if present */ + } + } + } + + /* Handle reaching the end of the expression, either ')' or end of pattern. + In the real compile phase, go back through the alternative branches and + reverse the chain of offsets, with the field in the BRA item now becoming an + offset to the first alternative. If there are no alternatives, it points to + the end of the group. The length in the terminating ket is always the length + of the whole bracketed item. Return leaving the pointer at the terminating + char. */ + + if (META_CODE(*pptr) != META_ALT) + { + if (lengthptr == NULL) + { + PCRE2_SIZE branch_length = code - last_branch; + do + { + PCRE2_SIZE prev_length = GET(last_branch, 1); + PUT(last_branch, 1, branch_length); + branch_length = prev_length; + last_branch -= branch_length; + } + while (branch_length > 0); + } + + /* Fill in the ket */ + + *code = OP_KET; + PUT(code, 1, (int)(code - start_bracket)); + code += 1 + LINK_SIZE; + + /* If it was a capturing subpattern, remove the block from the chain. */ + + if (capnumber > 0) cb->open_caps = cb->open_caps->next; + + /* Set values to pass back */ + + *codeptr = code; + *pptrptr = pptr; + *firstcuptr = firstcu; + *firstcuflagsptr = firstcuflags; + *reqcuptr = reqcu; + *reqcuflagsptr = reqcuflags; + if (lengthptr != NULL) + { + if (OFLOW_MAX - *lengthptr < length) + { + *errorcodeptr = ERR20; + return 0; + } + *lengthptr += length; + } + return okreturn; + } + + /* Another branch follows. In the pre-compile phase, we can move the code + pointer back to where it was for the start of the first branch. (That is, + pretend that each branch is the only one.) + + In the real compile phase, insert an ALT node. Its length field points back + to the previous branch while the bracket remains open. At the end the chain + is reversed. It's done like this so that the start of the bracket has a + zero offset until it is closed, making it possible to detect recursion. */ + + if (lengthptr != NULL) + { + code = *codeptr + 1 + LINK_SIZE + skipunits; + length += 1 + LINK_SIZE; + } + else + { + *code = OP_ALT; + PUT(code, 1, (int)(code - last_branch)); + bc.current_branch = last_branch = code; + code += 1 + LINK_SIZE; + } + + /* Set the lookbehind length (if not in a lookbehind the value will be zero) + and then advance past the vertical bar. */ + + lookbehindlength = META_DATA(*pptr); + pptr++; + } +/* Control never reaches here */ +} + + + +/************************************************* +* Check for anchored pattern * +*************************************************/ + +/* Try to find out if this is an anchored regular expression. Consider each +alternative branch. If they all start with OP_SOD or OP_CIRC, or with a bracket +all of whose alternatives start with OP_SOD or OP_CIRC (recurse ad lib), then +it's anchored. However, if this is a multiline pattern, then only OP_SOD will +be found, because ^ generates OP_CIRCM in that mode. + +We can also consider a regex to be anchored if OP_SOM starts all its branches. +This is the code for \G, which means "match at start of match position, taking +into account the match offset". + +A branch is also implicitly anchored if it starts with .* and DOTALL is set, +because that will try the rest of the pattern at all possible matching points, +so there is no point trying again.... er .... + +.... except when the .* appears inside capturing parentheses, and there is a +subsequent back reference to those parentheses. We haven't enough information +to catch that case precisely. + +At first, the best we could do was to detect when .* was in capturing brackets +and the highest back reference was greater than or equal to that level. +However, by keeping a bitmap of the first 31 back references, we can catch some +of the more common cases more precisely. + +... A second exception is when the .* appears inside an atomic group, because +this prevents the number of characters it matches from being adjusted. + +Arguments: + code points to start of the compiled pattern + bracket_map a bitmap of which brackets we are inside while testing; this + handles up to substring 31; after that we just have to take + the less precise approach + cb points to the compile data block + atomcount atomic group level + inassert TRUE if in an assertion + +Returns: TRUE or FALSE +*/ + +static BOOL +is_anchored(PCRE2_SPTR code, uint32_t bracket_map, compile_block *cb, + int atomcount, BOOL inassert) +{ +do { + PCRE2_SPTR scode = first_significant_code( + code + PRIV(OP_lengths)[*code], FALSE); + int op = *scode; + + /* Non-capturing brackets */ + + if (op == OP_BRA || op == OP_BRAPOS || + op == OP_SBRA || op == OP_SBRAPOS) + { + if (!is_anchored(scode, bracket_map, cb, atomcount, inassert)) + return FALSE; + } + + /* Capturing brackets */ + + else if (op == OP_CBRA || op == OP_CBRAPOS || + op == OP_SCBRA || op == OP_SCBRAPOS) + { + int n = GET2(scode, 1+LINK_SIZE); + uint32_t new_map = bracket_map | ((n < 32)? (1u << n) : 1); + if (!is_anchored(scode, new_map, cb, atomcount, inassert)) return FALSE; + } + + /* Positive forward assertion */ + + else if (op == OP_ASSERT || op == OP_ASSERT_NA) + { + if (!is_anchored(scode, bracket_map, cb, atomcount, TRUE)) return FALSE; + } + + /* Condition. If there is no second branch, it can't be anchored. */ + + else if (op == OP_COND || op == OP_SCOND) + { + if (scode[GET(scode,1)] != OP_ALT) return FALSE; + if (!is_anchored(scode, bracket_map, cb, atomcount, inassert)) + return FALSE; + } + + /* Atomic groups */ + + else if (op == OP_ONCE) + { + if (!is_anchored(scode, bracket_map, cb, atomcount + 1, inassert)) + return FALSE; + } + + /* .* is not anchored unless DOTALL is set (which generates OP_ALLANY) and + it isn't in brackets that are or may be referenced or inside an atomic + group or an assertion. Also the pattern must not contain *PRUNE or *SKIP, + because these break the feature. Consider, for example, /(?s).*?(*PRUNE)b/ + with the subject "aab", which matches "b", i.e. not at the start of a line. + There is also an option that disables auto-anchoring. */ + + else if ((op == OP_TYPESTAR || op == OP_TYPEMINSTAR || + op == OP_TYPEPOSSTAR)) + { + if (scode[1] != OP_ALLANY || (bracket_map & cb->backref_map) != 0 || + atomcount > 0 || cb->had_pruneorskip || inassert || + (cb->external_options & PCRE2_NO_DOTSTAR_ANCHOR) != 0) + return FALSE; + } + + /* Check for explicit anchoring */ + + else if (op != OP_SOD && op != OP_SOM && op != OP_CIRC) return FALSE; + + code += GET(code, 1); + } +while (*code == OP_ALT); /* Loop for each alternative */ +return TRUE; +} + + + +/************************************************* +* Check for starting with ^ or .* * +*************************************************/ + +/* This is called to find out if every branch starts with ^ or .* so that +"first char" processing can be done to speed things up in multiline +matching and for non-DOTALL patterns that start with .* (which must start at +the beginning or after \n). As in the case of is_anchored() (see above), we +have to take account of back references to capturing brackets that contain .* +because in that case we can't make the assumption. Also, the appearance of .* +inside atomic brackets or in an assertion, or in a pattern that contains *PRUNE +or *SKIP does not count, because once again the assumption no longer holds. + +Arguments: + code points to start of the compiled pattern or a group + bracket_map a bitmap of which brackets we are inside while testing; this + handles up to substring 31; after that we just have to take + the less precise approach + cb points to the compile data + atomcount atomic group level + inassert TRUE if in an assertion + +Returns: TRUE or FALSE +*/ + +static BOOL +is_startline(PCRE2_SPTR code, unsigned int bracket_map, compile_block *cb, + int atomcount, BOOL inassert) +{ +do { + PCRE2_SPTR scode = first_significant_code( + code + PRIV(OP_lengths)[*code], FALSE); + int op = *scode; + + /* If we are at the start of a conditional assertion group, *both* the + conditional assertion *and* what follows the condition must satisfy the test + for start of line. Other kinds of condition fail. Note that there may be an + auto-callout at the start of a condition. */ + + if (op == OP_COND) + { + scode += 1 + LINK_SIZE; + + if (*scode == OP_CALLOUT) scode += PRIV(OP_lengths)[OP_CALLOUT]; + else if (*scode == OP_CALLOUT_STR) scode += GET(scode, 1 + 2*LINK_SIZE); + + switch (*scode) + { + case OP_CREF: + case OP_DNCREF: + case OP_RREF: + case OP_DNRREF: + case OP_FAIL: + case OP_FALSE: + case OP_TRUE: + return FALSE; + + default: /* Assertion */ + if (!is_startline(scode, bracket_map, cb, atomcount, TRUE)) return FALSE; + do scode += GET(scode, 1); while (*scode == OP_ALT); + scode += 1 + LINK_SIZE; + break; + } + scode = first_significant_code(scode, FALSE); + op = *scode; + } + + /* Non-capturing brackets */ + + if (op == OP_BRA || op == OP_BRAPOS || + op == OP_SBRA || op == OP_SBRAPOS) + { + if (!is_startline(scode, bracket_map, cb, atomcount, inassert)) + return FALSE; + } + + /* Capturing brackets */ + + else if (op == OP_CBRA || op == OP_CBRAPOS || + op == OP_SCBRA || op == OP_SCBRAPOS) + { + int n = GET2(scode, 1+LINK_SIZE); + unsigned int new_map = bracket_map | ((n < 32)? (1u << n) : 1); + if (!is_startline(scode, new_map, cb, atomcount, inassert)) return FALSE; + } + + /* Positive forward assertions */ + + else if (op == OP_ASSERT || op == OP_ASSERT_NA) + { + if (!is_startline(scode, bracket_map, cb, atomcount, TRUE)) + return FALSE; + } + + /* Atomic brackets */ + + else if (op == OP_ONCE) + { + if (!is_startline(scode, bracket_map, cb, atomcount + 1, inassert)) + return FALSE; + } + + /* .* means "start at start or after \n" if it isn't in atomic brackets or + brackets that may be referenced or an assertion, and as long as the pattern + does not contain *PRUNE or *SKIP, because these break the feature. Consider, + for example, /.*?a(*PRUNE)b/ with the subject "aab", which matches "ab", + i.e. not at the start of a line. There is also an option that disables this + optimization. */ + + else if (op == OP_TYPESTAR || op == OP_TYPEMINSTAR || op == OP_TYPEPOSSTAR) + { + if (scode[1] != OP_ANY || (bracket_map & cb->backref_map) != 0 || + atomcount > 0 || cb->had_pruneorskip || inassert || + (cb->external_options & PCRE2_NO_DOTSTAR_ANCHOR) != 0) + return FALSE; + } + + /* Check for explicit circumflex; anything else gives a FALSE result. Note + in particular that this includes atomic brackets OP_ONCE because the number + of characters matched by .* cannot be adjusted inside them. */ + + else if (op != OP_CIRC && op != OP_CIRCM) return FALSE; + + /* Move on to the next alternative */ + + code += GET(code, 1); + } +while (*code == OP_ALT); /* Loop for each alternative */ +return TRUE; +} + + + +/************************************************* +* Scan compiled regex for recursion reference * +*************************************************/ + +/* This function scans through a compiled pattern until it finds an instance of +OP_RECURSE. + +Arguments: + code points to start of expression + utf TRUE in UTF mode + +Returns: pointer to the opcode for OP_RECURSE, or NULL if not found +*/ + +static PCRE2_SPTR +find_recurse(PCRE2_SPTR code, BOOL utf) +{ +for (;;) + { + PCRE2_UCHAR c = *code; + if (c == OP_END) return NULL; + if (c == OP_RECURSE) return code; + + /* XCLASS is used for classes that cannot be represented just by a bit map. + This includes negated single high-valued characters. CALLOUT_STR is used for + callouts with string arguments. In both cases the length in the table is + zero; the actual length is stored in the compiled code. */ + + if (c == OP_XCLASS) code += GET(code, 1); + else if (c == OP_CALLOUT_STR) code += GET(code, 1 + 2*LINK_SIZE); + + /* Otherwise, we can get the item's length from the table, except that for + repeated character types, we have to test for \p and \P, which have an extra + two code units of parameters, and for MARK/PRUNE/SKIP/THEN with an argument, + we must add in its length. */ + + else + { + switch(c) + { + case OP_TYPESTAR: + case OP_TYPEMINSTAR: + case OP_TYPEPLUS: + case OP_TYPEMINPLUS: + case OP_TYPEQUERY: + case OP_TYPEMINQUERY: + case OP_TYPEPOSSTAR: + case OP_TYPEPOSPLUS: + case OP_TYPEPOSQUERY: + if (code[1] == OP_PROP || code[1] == OP_NOTPROP) code += 2; + break; + + case OP_TYPEPOSUPTO: + case OP_TYPEUPTO: + case OP_TYPEMINUPTO: + case OP_TYPEEXACT: + if (code[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_PROP || code[1 + IMM2_SIZE] == OP_NOTPROP) + code += 2; + break; + + case OP_MARK: + case OP_COMMIT_ARG: + case OP_PRUNE_ARG: + case OP_SKIP_ARG: + case OP_THEN_ARG: + code += code[1]; + break; + } + + /* Add in the fixed length from the table */ + + code += PRIV(OP_lengths)[c]; + + /* In UTF-8 and UTF-16 modes, opcodes that are followed by a character may + be followed by a multi-unit character. The length in the table is a + minimum, so we have to arrange to skip the extra units. */ + +#ifdef MAYBE_UTF_MULTI + if (utf) switch(c) + { + case OP_CHAR: + case OP_CHARI: + case OP_NOT: + case OP_NOTI: + case OP_EXACT: + case OP_EXACTI: + case OP_NOTEXACT: + case OP_NOTEXACTI: + case OP_UPTO: + case OP_UPTOI: + case OP_NOTUPTO: + case OP_NOTUPTOI: + case OP_MINUPTO: + case OP_MINUPTOI: + case OP_NOTMINUPTO: + case OP_NOTMINUPTOI: + case OP_POSUPTO: + case OP_POSUPTOI: + case OP_NOTPOSUPTO: + case OP_NOTPOSUPTOI: + case OP_STAR: + case OP_STARI: + case OP_NOTSTAR: + case OP_NOTSTARI: + case OP_MINSTAR: + case OP_MINSTARI: + case OP_NOTMINSTAR: + case OP_NOTMINSTARI: + case OP_POSSTAR: + case OP_POSSTARI: + case OP_NOTPOSSTAR: + case OP_NOTPOSSTARI: + case OP_PLUS: + case OP_PLUSI: + case OP_NOTPLUS: + case OP_NOTPLUSI: + case OP_MINPLUS: + case OP_MINPLUSI: + case OP_NOTMINPLUS: + case OP_NOTMINPLUSI: + case OP_POSPLUS: + case OP_POSPLUSI: + case OP_NOTPOSPLUS: + case OP_NOTPOSPLUSI: + case OP_QUERY: + case OP_QUERYI: + case OP_NOTQUERY: + case OP_NOTQUERYI: + case OP_MINQUERY: + case OP_MINQUERYI: + case OP_NOTMINQUERY: + case OP_NOTMINQUERYI: + case OP_POSQUERY: + case OP_POSQUERYI: + case OP_NOTPOSQUERY: + case OP_NOTPOSQUERYI: + if (HAS_EXTRALEN(code[-1])) code += GET_EXTRALEN(code[-1]); + break; + } +#else + (void)(utf); /* Keep compiler happy by referencing function argument */ +#endif /* MAYBE_UTF_MULTI */ + } + } +} + + + +/************************************************* +* Check for asserted fixed first code unit * +*************************************************/ + +/* During compilation, the "first code unit" settings from forward assertions +are discarded, because they can cause conflicts with actual literals that +follow. However, if we end up without a first code unit setting for an +unanchored pattern, it is worth scanning the regex to see if there is an +initial asserted first code unit. If all branches start with the same asserted +code unit, or with a non-conditional bracket all of whose alternatives start +with the same asserted code unit (recurse ad lib), then we return that code +unit, with the flags set to zero or REQ_CASELESS; otherwise return zero with +REQ_NONE in the flags. + +Arguments: + code points to start of compiled pattern + flags points to the first code unit flags + inassert non-zero if in an assertion + +Returns: the fixed first code unit, or 0 with REQ_NONE in flags +*/ + +static uint32_t +find_firstassertedcu(PCRE2_SPTR code, uint32_t *flags, uint32_t inassert) +{ +uint32_t c = 0; +uint32_t cflags = REQ_NONE; + +*flags = REQ_NONE; +do { + uint32_t d; + uint32_t dflags; + int xl = (*code == OP_CBRA || *code == OP_SCBRA || + *code == OP_CBRAPOS || *code == OP_SCBRAPOS)? IMM2_SIZE:0; + PCRE2_SPTR scode = first_significant_code(code + 1+LINK_SIZE + xl, TRUE); + PCRE2_UCHAR op = *scode; + + switch(op) + { + default: + return 0; + + case OP_BRA: + case OP_BRAPOS: + case OP_CBRA: + case OP_SCBRA: + case OP_CBRAPOS: + case OP_SCBRAPOS: + case OP_ASSERT: + case OP_ASSERT_NA: + case OP_ONCE: + case OP_SCRIPT_RUN: + d = find_firstassertedcu(scode, &dflags, inassert + + ((op == OP_ASSERT || op == OP_ASSERT_NA)?1:0)); + if (dflags >= REQ_NONE) return 0; + if (cflags >= REQ_NONE) { c = d; cflags = dflags; } + else if (c != d || cflags != dflags) return 0; + break; + + case OP_EXACT: + scode += IMM2_SIZE; + /* Fall through */ + + case OP_CHAR: + case OP_PLUS: + case OP_MINPLUS: + case OP_POSPLUS: + if (inassert == 0) return 0; + if (cflags >= REQ_NONE) { c = scode[1]; cflags = 0; } + else if (c != scode[1]) return 0; + break; + + case OP_EXACTI: + scode += IMM2_SIZE; + /* Fall through */ + + case OP_CHARI: + case OP_PLUSI: + case OP_MINPLUSI: + case OP_POSPLUSI: + if (inassert == 0) return 0; + + /* If the character is more than one code unit long, we cannot set its + first code unit when matching caselessly. Later scanning may pick up + multiple code units. */ + +#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE +#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 8 + if (scode[1] >= 0x80) return 0; +#elif PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 16 + if (scode[1] >= 0xd800 && scode[1] <= 0xdfff) return 0; +#endif +#endif + + if (cflags >= REQ_NONE) { c = scode[1]; cflags = REQ_CASELESS; } + else if (c != scode[1]) return 0; + break; + } + + code += GET(code, 1); + } +while (*code == OP_ALT); + +*flags = cflags; +return c; +} + + + +/************************************************* +* Add an entry to the name/number table * +*************************************************/ + +/* This function is called between compiling passes to add an entry to the +name/number table, maintaining alphabetical order. Checking for permitted +and forbidden duplicates has already been done. + +Arguments: + cb the compile data block + name the name to add + length the length of the name + groupno the group number + tablecount the count of names in the table so far + +Returns: nothing +*/ + +static void +add_name_to_table(compile_block *cb, PCRE2_SPTR name, int length, + unsigned int groupno, uint32_t tablecount) +{ +uint32_t i; +PCRE2_UCHAR *slot = cb->name_table; + +for (i = 0; i < tablecount; i++) + { + int crc = memcmp(name, slot+IMM2_SIZE, CU2BYTES(length)); + if (crc == 0 && slot[IMM2_SIZE+length] != 0) + crc = -1; /* Current name is a substring */ + + /* Make space in the table and break the loop for an earlier name. For a + duplicate or later name, carry on. We do this for duplicates so that in the + simple case (when ?(| is not used) they are in order of their numbers. In all + cases they are in the order in which they appear in the pattern. */ + + if (crc < 0) + { + (void)memmove(slot + cb->name_entry_size, slot, + CU2BYTES((tablecount - i) * cb->name_entry_size)); + break; + } + + /* Continue the loop for a later or duplicate name */ + + slot += cb->name_entry_size; + } + +PUT2(slot, 0, groupno); +memcpy(slot + IMM2_SIZE, name, CU2BYTES(length)); + +/* Add a terminating zero and fill the rest of the slot with zeroes so that +the memory is all initialized. Otherwise valgrind moans about uninitialized +memory when saving serialized compiled patterns. */ + +memset(slot + IMM2_SIZE + length, 0, + CU2BYTES(cb->name_entry_size - length - IMM2_SIZE)); +} + + + +/************************************************* +* Skip in parsed pattern * +*************************************************/ + +/* This function is called to skip parts of the parsed pattern when finding the +length of a lookbehind branch. It is called after (*ACCEPT) and (*FAIL) to find +the end of the branch, it is called to skip over an internal lookaround or +(DEFINE) group, and it is also called to skip to the end of a class, during +which it will never encounter nested groups (but there's no need to have +special code for that). + +When called to find the end of a branch or group, pptr must point to the first +meta code inside the branch, not the branch-starting code. In other cases it +can point to the item that causes the function to be called. + +Arguments: + pptr current pointer to skip from + skiptype PSKIP_CLASS when skipping to end of class + PSKIP_ALT when META_ALT ends the skip + PSKIP_KET when only META_KET ends the skip + +Returns: new value of pptr + NULL if META_END is reached - should never occur + or for an unknown meta value - likewise +*/ + +static uint32_t * +parsed_skip(uint32_t *pptr, uint32_t skiptype) +{ +uint32_t nestlevel = 0; + +for (;; pptr++) + { + uint32_t meta = META_CODE(*pptr); + + switch(meta) + { + default: /* Just skip over most items */ + if (meta < META_END) continue; /* Literal */ + break; + + /* This should never occur. */ + + case META_END: + return NULL; + + /* The data for these items is variable in length. */ + + case META_BACKREF: /* Offset is present only if group >= 10 */ + if (META_DATA(*pptr) >= 10) pptr += SIZEOFFSET; + break; + + case META_ESCAPE: /* A few escapes are followed by data items. */ + switch (META_DATA(*pptr)) + { + case ESC_P: + case ESC_p: + pptr += 1; + break; + + case ESC_g: + case ESC_k: + pptr += 1 + SIZEOFFSET; + break; + } + break; + + case META_MARK: /* Add the length of the name. */ + case META_COMMIT_ARG: + case META_PRUNE_ARG: + case META_SKIP_ARG: + case META_THEN_ARG: + pptr += pptr[1]; + break; + + /* These are the "active" items in this loop. */ + + case META_CLASS_END: + if (skiptype == PSKIP_CLASS) return pptr; + break; + + case META_ATOMIC: + case META_CAPTURE: + case META_COND_ASSERT: + case META_COND_DEFINE: + case META_COND_NAME: + case META_COND_NUMBER: + case META_COND_RNAME: + case META_COND_RNUMBER: + case META_COND_VERSION: + case META_LOOKAHEAD: + case META_LOOKAHEADNOT: + case META_LOOKAHEAD_NA: + case META_LOOKBEHIND: + case META_LOOKBEHINDNOT: + case META_LOOKBEHIND_NA: + case META_NOCAPTURE: + case META_SCRIPT_RUN: + nestlevel++; + break; + + case META_ALT: + if (nestlevel == 0 && skiptype == PSKIP_ALT) return pptr; + break; + + case META_KET: + if (nestlevel == 0) return pptr; + nestlevel--; + break; + } + + /* The extra data item length for each meta is in a table. */ + + meta = (meta >> 16) & 0x7fff; + if (meta >= sizeof(meta_extra_lengths)) return NULL; + pptr += meta_extra_lengths[meta]; + } +/* Control never reaches here */ +return pptr; +} + + + +/************************************************* +* Find length of a parsed group * +*************************************************/ + +/* This is called for nested groups within a branch of a lookbehind whose +length is being computed. If all the branches in the nested group have the same +length, that is OK. On entry, the pointer must be at the first element after +the group initializing code. On exit it points to OP_KET. Caching is used to +improve processing speed when the same capturing group occurs many times. + +Arguments: + pptrptr pointer to pointer in the parsed pattern + isinline FALSE if a reference or recursion; TRUE for inline group + errcodeptr pointer to the errorcode + lcptr pointer to the loop counter + group number of captured group or -1 for a non-capturing group + recurses chain of recurse_check to catch mutual recursion + cb pointer to the compile data + +Returns: the group length or a negative number +*/ + +static int +get_grouplength(uint32_t **pptrptr, BOOL isinline, int *errcodeptr, int *lcptr, + int group, parsed_recurse_check *recurses, compile_block *cb) +{ +int branchlength; +int grouplength = -1; + +/* The cache can be used only if there is no possibility of there being two +groups with the same number. We do not need to set the end pointer for a group +that is being processed as a back reference or recursion, but we must do so for +an inline group. */ + +if (group > 0 && (cb->external_flags & PCRE2_DUPCAPUSED) == 0) + { + uint32_t groupinfo = cb->groupinfo[group]; + if ((groupinfo & GI_NOT_FIXED_LENGTH) != 0) return -1; + if ((groupinfo & GI_SET_FIXED_LENGTH) != 0) + { + if (isinline) *pptrptr = parsed_skip(*pptrptr, PSKIP_KET); + return groupinfo & GI_FIXED_LENGTH_MASK; + } + } + +/* Scan the group. In this case we find the end pointer of necessity. */ + +for(;;) + { + branchlength = get_branchlength(pptrptr, errcodeptr, lcptr, recurses, cb); + if (branchlength < 0) goto ISNOTFIXED; + if (grouplength == -1) grouplength = branchlength; + else if (grouplength != branchlength) goto ISNOTFIXED; + if (**pptrptr == META_KET) break; + *pptrptr += 1; /* Skip META_ALT */ + } + +if (group > 0) + cb->groupinfo[group] |= (uint32_t)(GI_SET_FIXED_LENGTH | grouplength); +return grouplength; + +ISNOTFIXED: +if (group > 0) cb->groupinfo[group] |= GI_NOT_FIXED_LENGTH; +return -1; +} + + + +/************************************************* +* Find length of a parsed branch * +*************************************************/ + +/* Return a fixed length for a branch in a lookbehind, giving an error if the +length is not fixed. On entry, *pptrptr points to the first element inside the +branch. On exit it is set to point to the ALT or KET. + +Arguments: + pptrptr pointer to pointer in the parsed pattern + errcodeptr pointer to error code + lcptr pointer to loop counter + recurses chain of recurse_check to catch mutual recursion + cb pointer to compile block + +Returns: the length, or a negative value on error +*/ + +static int +get_branchlength(uint32_t **pptrptr, int *errcodeptr, int *lcptr, + parsed_recurse_check *recurses, compile_block *cb) +{ +int branchlength = 0; +int grouplength; +uint32_t lastitemlength = 0; +uint32_t *pptr = *pptrptr; +PCRE2_SIZE offset; +parsed_recurse_check this_recurse; + +/* A large and/or complex regex can take too long to process. This can happen +more often when (?| groups are present in the pattern because their length +cannot be cached. */ + +if ((*lcptr)++ > 2000) + { + *errcodeptr = ERR35; /* Lookbehind is too complicated */ + return -1; + } + +/* Scan the branch, accumulating the length. */ + +for (;; pptr++) + { + parsed_recurse_check *r; + uint32_t *gptr, *gptrend; + uint32_t escape; + uint32_t group = 0; + uint32_t itemlength = 0; + + if (*pptr < META_END) + { + itemlength = 1; + } + + else switch (META_CODE(*pptr)) + { + case META_KET: + case META_ALT: + goto EXIT; + + /* (*ACCEPT) and (*FAIL) terminate the branch, but we must skip to the + actual termination. */ + + case META_ACCEPT: + case META_FAIL: + pptr = parsed_skip(pptr, PSKIP_ALT); + if (pptr == NULL) goto PARSED_SKIP_FAILED; + goto EXIT; + + case META_MARK: + case META_COMMIT_ARG: + case META_PRUNE_ARG: + case META_SKIP_ARG: + case META_THEN_ARG: + pptr += pptr[1] + 1; + break; + + case META_CIRCUMFLEX: + case META_COMMIT: + case META_DOLLAR: + case META_PRUNE: + case META_SKIP: + case META_THEN: + break; + + case META_OPTIONS: + pptr += 1; + break; + + case META_BIGVALUE: + itemlength = 1; + pptr += 1; + break; + + case META_CLASS: + case META_CLASS_NOT: + itemlength = 1; + pptr = parsed_skip(pptr, PSKIP_CLASS); + if (pptr == NULL) goto PARSED_SKIP_FAILED; + break; + + case META_CLASS_EMPTY_NOT: + case META_DOT: + itemlength = 1; + break; + + case META_CALLOUT_NUMBER: + pptr += 3; + break; + + case META_CALLOUT_STRING: + pptr += 3 + SIZEOFFSET; + break; + + /* Only some escapes consume a character. Of those, \R and \X are never + allowed because they might match more than character. \C is allowed only in + 32-bit and non-UTF 8/16-bit modes. */ + + case META_ESCAPE: + escape = META_DATA(*pptr); + if (escape == ESC_R || escape == ESC_X) return -1; + if (escape > ESC_b && escape < ESC_Z) + { +#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH != 32 + if ((cb->external_options & PCRE2_UTF) != 0 && escape == ESC_C) + { + *errcodeptr = ERR36; + return -1; + } +#endif + itemlength = 1; + if (escape == ESC_p || escape == ESC_P) pptr++; /* Skip prop data */ + } + break; + + /* Lookaheads do not contribute to the length of this branch, but they may + contain lookbehinds within them whose lengths need to be set. */ + + case META_LOOKAHEAD: + case META_LOOKAHEADNOT: + case META_LOOKAHEAD_NA: + *errcodeptr = check_lookbehinds(pptr + 1, &pptr, recurses, cb, lcptr); + if (*errcodeptr != 0) return -1; + + /* Ignore any qualifiers that follow a lookahead assertion. */ + + switch (pptr[1]) + { + case META_ASTERISK: + case META_ASTERISK_PLUS: + case META_ASTERISK_QUERY: + case META_PLUS: + case META_PLUS_PLUS: + case META_PLUS_QUERY: + case META_QUERY: + case META_QUERY_PLUS: + case META_QUERY_QUERY: + pptr++; + break; + + case META_MINMAX: + case META_MINMAX_PLUS: + case META_MINMAX_QUERY: + pptr += 3; + break; + + default: + break; + } + break; + + /* A nested lookbehind does not contribute any length to this lookbehind, + but must itself be checked and have its lengths set. */ + + case META_LOOKBEHIND: + case META_LOOKBEHINDNOT: + case META_LOOKBEHIND_NA: + if (!set_lookbehind_lengths(&pptr, errcodeptr, lcptr, recurses, cb)) + return -1; + break; + + /* Back references and recursions are handled by very similar code. At this + stage, the names generated in the parsing pass are available, but the main + name table has not yet been created. So for the named varieties, scan the + list of names in order to get the number of the first one in the pattern, + and whether or not this name is duplicated. */ + + case META_BACKREF_BYNAME: + if ((cb->external_options & PCRE2_MATCH_UNSET_BACKREF) != 0) + goto ISNOTFIXED; + /* Fall through */ + + case META_RECURSE_BYNAME: + { + int i; + PCRE2_SPTR name; + BOOL is_dupname = FALSE; + named_group *ng = cb->named_groups; + uint32_t meta_code = META_CODE(*pptr); + uint32_t length = *(++pptr); + + GETPLUSOFFSET(offset, pptr); + name = cb->start_pattern + offset; + for (i = 0; i < cb->names_found; i++, ng++) + { + if (length == ng->length && PRIV(strncmp)(name, ng->name, length) == 0) + { + group = ng->number; + is_dupname = ng->isdup; + break; + } + } + + if (group == 0) + { + *errcodeptr = ERR15; /* Non-existent subpattern */ + cb->erroroffset = offset; + return -1; + } + + /* A numerical back reference can be fixed length if duplicate capturing + groups are not being used. A non-duplicate named back reference can also + be handled. */ + + if (meta_code == META_RECURSE_BYNAME || + (!is_dupname && (cb->external_flags & PCRE2_DUPCAPUSED) == 0)) + goto RECURSE_OR_BACKREF_LENGTH; /* Handle as a numbered version. */ + } + goto ISNOTFIXED; /* Duplicate name or number */ + + /* The offset values for back references < 10 are in a separate vector + because otherwise they would use more than two parsed pattern elements on + 64-bit systems. */ + + case META_BACKREF: + if ((cb->external_options & PCRE2_MATCH_UNSET_BACKREF) != 0 || + (cb->external_flags & PCRE2_DUPCAPUSED) != 0) + goto ISNOTFIXED; + group = META_DATA(*pptr); + if (group < 10) + { + offset = cb->small_ref_offset[group]; + goto RECURSE_OR_BACKREF_LENGTH; + } + + /* Fall through */ + /* For groups >= 10 - picking up group twice does no harm. */ + + /* A true recursion implies not fixed length, but a subroutine call may + be OK. Back reference "recursions" are also failed. */ + + case META_RECURSE: + group = META_DATA(*pptr); + GETPLUSOFFSET(offset, pptr); + + RECURSE_OR_BACKREF_LENGTH: + if (group > cb->bracount) + { + cb->erroroffset = offset; + *errcodeptr = ERR15; /* Non-existent subpattern */ + return -1; + } + if (group == 0) goto ISNOTFIXED; /* Local recursion */ + for (gptr = cb->parsed_pattern; *gptr != META_END; gptr++) + { + if (META_CODE(*gptr) == META_BIGVALUE) gptr++; + else if (*gptr == (META_CAPTURE | group)) break; + } + + /* We must start the search for the end of the group at the first meta code + inside the group. Otherwise it will be treated as an enclosed group. */ + + gptrend = parsed_skip(gptr + 1, PSKIP_KET); + if (gptrend == NULL) goto PARSED_SKIP_FAILED; + if (pptr > gptr && pptr < gptrend) goto ISNOTFIXED; /* Local recursion */ + for (r = recurses; r != NULL; r = r->prev) if (r->groupptr == gptr) break; + if (r != NULL) goto ISNOTFIXED; /* Mutual recursion */ + this_recurse.prev = recurses; + this_recurse.groupptr = gptr; + + /* We do not need to know the position of the end of the group, that is, + gptr is not used after the call to get_grouplength(). Setting the second + argument FALSE stops it scanning for the end when the length can be found + in the cache. */ + + gptr++; + grouplength = get_grouplength(&gptr, FALSE, errcodeptr, lcptr, group, + &this_recurse, cb); + if (grouplength < 0) + { + if (*errcodeptr == 0) goto ISNOTFIXED; + return -1; /* Error already set */ + } + itemlength = grouplength; + break; + + /* A (DEFINE) group is never obeyed inline and so it does not contribute to + the length of this branch. Skip from the following item to the next + unpaired ket. */ + + case META_COND_DEFINE: + pptr = parsed_skip(pptr + 1, PSKIP_KET); + break; + + /* Check other nested groups - advance past the initial data for each type + and then seek a fixed length with get_grouplength(). */ + + case META_COND_NAME: + case META_COND_NUMBER: + case META_COND_RNAME: + case META_COND_RNUMBER: + pptr += 2 + SIZEOFFSET; + goto CHECK_GROUP; + + case META_COND_ASSERT: + pptr += 1; + goto CHECK_GROUP; + + case META_COND_VERSION: + pptr += 4; + goto CHECK_GROUP; + + case META_CAPTURE: + group = META_DATA(*pptr); + /* Fall through */ + + case META_ATOMIC: + case META_NOCAPTURE: + case META_SCRIPT_RUN: + pptr++; + CHECK_GROUP: + grouplength = get_grouplength(&pptr, TRUE, errcodeptr, lcptr, group, + recurses, cb); + if (grouplength < 0) return -1; + itemlength = grouplength; + break; + + /* Exact repetition is OK; variable repetition is not. A repetition of zero + must subtract the length that has already been added. */ + + case META_MINMAX: + case META_MINMAX_PLUS: + case META_MINMAX_QUERY: + if (pptr[1] == pptr[2]) + { + switch(pptr[1]) + { + case 0: + branchlength -= lastitemlength; + break; + + case 1: + itemlength = 0; + break; + + default: /* Check for integer overflow */ + if (lastitemlength != 0 && /* Should not occur, but just in case */ + INT_MAX/lastitemlength < pptr[1] - 1) + { + *errcodeptr = ERR87; /* Integer overflow; lookbehind too big */ + return -1; + } + itemlength = (pptr[1] - 1) * lastitemlength; + break; + } + pptr += 2; + break; + } + /* Fall through */ + + /* Any other item means this branch does not have a fixed length. */ + + default: + ISNOTFIXED: + *errcodeptr = ERR25; /* Not fixed length */ + return -1; + } + + /* Add the item length to the branchlength, checking for integer overflow and + for the branch length exceeding the limit. */ + + if (INT_MAX - branchlength < (int)itemlength || + (branchlength += itemlength) > LOOKBEHIND_MAX) + { + *errcodeptr = ERR87; + return -1; + } + + /* Save this item length for use if the next item is a quantifier. */ + + lastitemlength = itemlength; + } + +EXIT: +*pptrptr = pptr; +return branchlength; + +PARSED_SKIP_FAILED: +*errcodeptr = ERR90; +return -1; +} + + + +/************************************************* +* Set lengths in a lookbehind * +*************************************************/ + +/* This function is called for each lookbehind, to set the lengths in its +branches. An error occurs if any branch does not have a fixed length that is +less than the maximum (65535). On exit, the pointer must be left on the final +ket. + +The function also maintains the max_lookbehind value. Any lookbehind branch +that contains a nested lookbehind may actually look further back than the +length of the branch. The additional amount is passed back from +get_branchlength() as an "extra" value. + +Arguments: + pptrptr pointer to pointer in the parsed pattern + errcodeptr pointer to error code + lcptr pointer to loop counter + recurses chain of recurse_check to catch mutual recursion + cb pointer to compile block + +Returns: TRUE if all is well + FALSE otherwise, with error code and offset set +*/ + +static BOOL +set_lookbehind_lengths(uint32_t **pptrptr, int *errcodeptr, int *lcptr, + parsed_recurse_check *recurses, compile_block *cb) +{ +PCRE2_SIZE offset; +int branchlength; +uint32_t *bptr = *pptrptr; + +READPLUSOFFSET(offset, bptr); /* Offset for error messages */ +*pptrptr += SIZEOFFSET; + +do + { + *pptrptr += 1; + branchlength = get_branchlength(pptrptr, errcodeptr, lcptr, recurses, cb); + if (branchlength < 0) + { + /* The errorcode and offset may already be set from a nested lookbehind. */ + if (*errcodeptr == 0) *errcodeptr = ERR25; + if (cb->erroroffset == PCRE2_UNSET) cb->erroroffset = offset; + return FALSE; + } + if (branchlength > cb->max_lookbehind) cb->max_lookbehind = branchlength; + *bptr |= branchlength; /* branchlength never more than 65535 */ + bptr = *pptrptr; + } +while (*bptr == META_ALT); + +return TRUE; +} + + + +/************************************************* +* Check parsed pattern lookbehinds * +*************************************************/ + +/* This function is called at the end of parsing a pattern if any lookbehinds +were encountered. It scans the parsed pattern for them, calling +set_lookbehind_lengths() for each one. At the start, the errorcode is zero and +the error offset is marked unset. The enables the functions above not to +override settings from deeper nestings. + +This function is called recursively from get_branchlength() for lookaheads in +order to process any lookbehinds that they may contain. It stops when it hits a +non-nested closing parenthesis in this case, returning a pointer to it. + +Arguments + pptr points to where to start (start of pattern or start of lookahead) + retptr if not NULL, return the ket pointer here + recurses chain of recurse_check to catch mutual recursion + cb points to the compile block + lcptr points to loop counter + +Returns: 0 on success, or an errorcode (cb->erroroffset will be set) +*/ + +static int +check_lookbehinds(uint32_t *pptr, uint32_t **retptr, + parsed_recurse_check *recurses, compile_block *cb, int *lcptr) +{ +int errorcode = 0; +int nestlevel = 0; + +cb->erroroffset = PCRE2_UNSET; + +for (; *pptr != META_END; pptr++) + { + if (*pptr < META_END) continue; /* Literal */ + + switch (META_CODE(*pptr)) + { + default: + return ERR70; /* Unrecognized meta code */ + + case META_ESCAPE: + if (*pptr - META_ESCAPE == ESC_P || *pptr - META_ESCAPE == ESC_p) + pptr += 1; + break; + + case META_KET: + if (--nestlevel < 0) + { + if (retptr != NULL) *retptr = pptr; + return 0; + } + break; + + case META_ATOMIC: + case META_CAPTURE: + case META_COND_ASSERT: + case META_LOOKAHEAD: + case META_LOOKAHEADNOT: + case META_LOOKAHEAD_NA: + case META_NOCAPTURE: + case META_SCRIPT_RUN: + nestlevel++; + break; + + case META_ACCEPT: + case META_ALT: + case META_ASTERISK: + case META_ASTERISK_PLUS: + case META_ASTERISK_QUERY: + case META_BACKREF: + case META_CIRCUMFLEX: + case META_CLASS: + case META_CLASS_EMPTY: + case META_CLASS_EMPTY_NOT: + case META_CLASS_END: + case META_CLASS_NOT: + case META_COMMIT: + case META_DOLLAR: + case META_DOT: + case META_FAIL: + case META_PLUS: + case META_PLUS_PLUS: + case META_PLUS_QUERY: + case META_PRUNE: + case META_QUERY: + case META_QUERY_PLUS: + case META_QUERY_QUERY: + case META_RANGE_ESCAPED: + case META_RANGE_LITERAL: + case META_SKIP: + case META_THEN: + break; + + case META_RECURSE: + pptr += SIZEOFFSET; + break; + + case META_BACKREF_BYNAME: + case META_RECURSE_BYNAME: + pptr += 1 + SIZEOFFSET; + break; + + case META_COND_DEFINE: + pptr += SIZEOFFSET; + nestlevel++; + break; + + case META_COND_NAME: + case META_COND_NUMBER: + case META_COND_RNAME: + case META_COND_RNUMBER: + pptr += 1 + SIZEOFFSET; + nestlevel++; + break; + + case META_COND_VERSION: + pptr += 3; + nestlevel++; + break; + + case META_CALLOUT_STRING: + pptr += 3 + SIZEOFFSET; + break; + + case META_BIGVALUE: + case META_OPTIONS: + case META_POSIX: + case META_POSIX_NEG: + pptr += 1; + break; + + case META_MINMAX: + case META_MINMAX_QUERY: + case META_MINMAX_PLUS: + pptr += 2; + break; + + case META_CALLOUT_NUMBER: + pptr += 3; + break; + + case META_MARK: + case META_COMMIT_ARG: + case META_PRUNE_ARG: + case META_SKIP_ARG: + case META_THEN_ARG: + pptr += 1 + pptr[1]; + break; + + case META_LOOKBEHIND: + case META_LOOKBEHINDNOT: + case META_LOOKBEHIND_NA: + if (!set_lookbehind_lengths(&pptr, &errorcode, lcptr, recurses, cb)) + return errorcode; + break; + } + } + +return 0; +} + + + +/************************************************* +* External function to compile a pattern * +*************************************************/ + +/* This function reads a regular expression in the form of a string and returns +a pointer to a block of store holding a compiled version of the expression. + +Arguments: + pattern the regular expression + patlen the length of the pattern, or PCRE2_ZERO_TERMINATED + options option bits + errorptr pointer to errorcode + erroroffset pointer to error offset + ccontext points to a compile context or is NULL + +Returns: pointer to compiled data block, or NULL on error, + with errorcode and erroroffset set +*/ + +PCRE2_EXP_DEFN pcre2_code * PCRE2_CALL_CONVENTION +pcre2_compile(PCRE2_SPTR pattern, PCRE2_SIZE patlen, uint32_t options, + int *errorptr, PCRE2_SIZE *erroroffset, pcre2_compile_context *ccontext) +{ +BOOL utf; /* Set TRUE for UTF mode */ +BOOL ucp; /* Set TRUE for UCP mode */ +BOOL has_lookbehind = FALSE; /* Set TRUE if a lookbehind is found */ +BOOL zero_terminated; /* Set TRUE for zero-terminated pattern */ +pcre2_real_code *re = NULL; /* What we will return */ +compile_block cb; /* "Static" compile-time data */ +const uint8_t *tables; /* Char tables base pointer */ + +PCRE2_UCHAR *code; /* Current pointer in compiled code */ +PCRE2_SPTR codestart; /* Start of compiled code */ +PCRE2_SPTR ptr; /* Current pointer in pattern */ +uint32_t *pptr; /* Current pointer in parsed pattern */ + +PCRE2_SIZE length = 1; /* Allow for final END opcode */ +PCRE2_SIZE usedlength; /* Actual length used */ +PCRE2_SIZE re_blocksize; /* Size of memory block */ +PCRE2_SIZE big32count = 0; /* 32-bit literals >= 0x80000000 */ +PCRE2_SIZE parsed_size_needed; /* Needed for parsed pattern */ + +uint32_t firstcuflags, reqcuflags; /* Type of first/req code unit */ +uint32_t firstcu, reqcu; /* Value of first/req code unit */ +uint32_t setflags = 0; /* NL and BSR set flags */ + +uint32_t skipatstart; /* When checking (*UTF) etc */ +uint32_t limit_heap = UINT32_MAX; +uint32_t limit_match = UINT32_MAX; /* Unset match limits */ +uint32_t limit_depth = UINT32_MAX; + +int newline = 0; /* Unset; can be set by the pattern */ +int bsr = 0; /* Unset; can be set by the pattern */ +int errorcode = 0; /* Initialize to avoid compiler warn */ +int regexrc; /* Return from compile */ + +uint32_t i; /* Local loop counter */ + +/* Comments at the head of this file explain about these variables. */ + +uint32_t stack_groupinfo[GROUPINFO_DEFAULT_SIZE]; +uint32_t stack_parsed_pattern[PARSED_PATTERN_DEFAULT_SIZE]; +named_group named_groups[NAMED_GROUP_LIST_SIZE]; + +/* The workspace is used in different ways in the different compiling phases. +It needs to be 16-bit aligned for the preliminary parsing scan. */ + +uint32_t c16workspace[C16_WORK_SIZE]; +PCRE2_UCHAR *cworkspace = (PCRE2_UCHAR *)c16workspace; + + +/* -------------- Check arguments and set up the pattern ----------------- */ + +/* There must be error code and offset pointers. */ + +if (errorptr == NULL || erroroffset == NULL) return NULL; +*errorptr = ERR0; +*erroroffset = 0; + +/* There must be a pattern! */ + +if (pattern == NULL) + { + *errorptr = ERR16; + return NULL; + } + +/* A NULL compile context means "use a default context" */ + +if (ccontext == NULL) + ccontext = (pcre2_compile_context *)(&PRIV(default_compile_context)); + +/* PCRE2_MATCH_INVALID_UTF implies UTF */ + +if ((options & PCRE2_MATCH_INVALID_UTF) != 0) options |= PCRE2_UTF; + +/* Check that all undefined public option bits are zero. */ + +if ((options & ~PUBLIC_COMPILE_OPTIONS) != 0 || + (ccontext->extra_options & ~PUBLIC_COMPILE_EXTRA_OPTIONS) != 0) + { + *errorptr = ERR17; + return NULL; + } + +if ((options & PCRE2_LITERAL) != 0 && + ((options & ~PUBLIC_LITERAL_COMPILE_OPTIONS) != 0 || + (ccontext->extra_options & ~PUBLIC_LITERAL_COMPILE_EXTRA_OPTIONS) != 0)) + { + *errorptr = ERR92; + return NULL; + } + +/* A zero-terminated pattern is indicated by the special length value +PCRE2_ZERO_TERMINATED. Check for an overlong pattern. */ + +if ((zero_terminated = (patlen == PCRE2_ZERO_TERMINATED))) + patlen = PRIV(strlen)(pattern); + +if (patlen > ccontext->max_pattern_length) + { + *errorptr = ERR88; + return NULL; + } + +/* From here on, all returns from this function should end up going via the +EXIT label. */ + + +/* ------------ Initialize the "static" compile data -------------- */ + +tables = (ccontext->tables != NULL)? ccontext->tables : PRIV(default_tables); + +cb.lcc = tables + lcc_offset; /* Individual */ +cb.fcc = tables + fcc_offset; /* character */ +cb.cbits = tables + cbits_offset; /* tables */ +cb.ctypes = tables + ctypes_offset; + +cb.assert_depth = 0; +cb.bracount = 0; +cb.cx = ccontext; +cb.dupnames = FALSE; +cb.end_pattern = pattern + patlen; +cb.erroroffset = 0; +cb.external_flags = 0; +cb.external_options = options; +cb.groupinfo = stack_groupinfo; +cb.had_recurse = FALSE; +cb.lastcapture = 0; +cb.max_lookbehind = 0; +cb.name_entry_size = 0; +cb.name_table = NULL; +cb.named_groups = named_groups; +cb.named_group_list_size = NAMED_GROUP_LIST_SIZE; +cb.names_found = 0; +cb.open_caps = NULL; +cb.parens_depth = 0; +cb.parsed_pattern = stack_parsed_pattern; +cb.req_varyopt = 0; +cb.start_code = cworkspace; +cb.start_pattern = pattern; +cb.start_workspace = cworkspace; +cb.workspace_size = COMPILE_WORK_SIZE; + +/* Maximum back reference and backref bitmap. The bitmap records up to 31 back +references to help in deciding whether (.*) can be treated as anchored or not. +*/ + +cb.top_backref = 0; +cb.backref_map = 0; + +/* Escape sequences \1 to \9 are always back references, but as they are only +two characters long, only two elements can be used in the parsed_pattern +vector. The first contains the reference, and we'd like to use the second to +record the offset in the pattern, so that forward references to non-existent +groups can be diagnosed later with an offset. However, on 64-bit systems, +PCRE2_SIZE won't fit. Instead, we have a vector of offsets for the first +occurrence of \1 to \9, indexed by the second parsed_pattern value. All other +references have enough space for the offset to be put into the parsed pattern. +*/ + +for (i = 0; i < 10; i++) cb.small_ref_offset[i] = PCRE2_UNSET; + + +/* --------------- Start looking at the pattern --------------- */ + +/* Unless PCRE2_LITERAL is set, check for global one-time option settings at +the start of the pattern, and remember the offset to the actual regex. With +valgrind support, make the terminator of a zero-terminated pattern +inaccessible. This catches bugs that would otherwise only show up for +non-zero-terminated patterns. */ + +#ifdef SUPPORT_VALGRIND +if (zero_terminated) VALGRIND_MAKE_MEM_NOACCESS(pattern + patlen, CU2BYTES(1)); +#endif + +ptr = pattern; +skipatstart = 0; + +if ((options & PCRE2_LITERAL) == 0) + { + while (patlen - skipatstart >= 2 && + ptr[skipatstart] == CHAR_LEFT_PARENTHESIS && + ptr[skipatstart+1] == CHAR_ASTERISK) + { + for (i = 0; i < sizeof(pso_list)/sizeof(pso); i++) + { + uint32_t c, pp; + pso *p = pso_list + i; + + if (patlen - skipatstart - 2 >= p->length && + PRIV(strncmp_c8)(ptr + skipatstart + 2, (char *)(p->name), + p->length) == 0) + { + skipatstart += p->length + 2; + switch(p->type) + { + case PSO_OPT: + cb.external_options |= p->value; + break; + + case PSO_FLG: + setflags |= p->value; + break; + + case PSO_NL: + newline = p->value; + setflags |= PCRE2_NL_SET; + break; + + case PSO_BSR: + bsr = p->value; + setflags |= PCRE2_BSR_SET; + break; + + case PSO_LIMM: + case PSO_LIMD: + case PSO_LIMH: + c = 0; + pp = skipatstart; + if (!IS_DIGIT(ptr[pp])) + { + errorcode = ERR60; + ptr += pp; + goto HAD_EARLY_ERROR; + } + while (IS_DIGIT(ptr[pp])) + { + if (c > UINT32_MAX / 10 - 1) break; /* Integer overflow */ + c = c*10 + (ptr[pp++] - CHAR_0); + } + if (ptr[pp++] != CHAR_RIGHT_PARENTHESIS) + { + errorcode = ERR60; + ptr += pp; + goto HAD_EARLY_ERROR; + } + if (p->type == PSO_LIMH) limit_heap = c; + else if (p->type == PSO_LIMM) limit_match = c; + else limit_depth = c; + skipatstart += pp - skipatstart; + break; + } + break; /* Out of the table scan loop */ + } + } + if (i >= sizeof(pso_list)/sizeof(pso)) break; /* Out of pso loop */ + } + } + +/* End of pattern-start options; advance to start of real regex. */ + +ptr += skipatstart; + +/* Can't support UTF or UCP if PCRE2 was built without Unicode support. */ + +#ifndef SUPPORT_UNICODE +if ((cb.external_options & (PCRE2_UTF|PCRE2_UCP)) != 0) + { + errorcode = ERR32; + goto HAD_EARLY_ERROR; + } +#endif + +/* Check UTF. We have the original options in 'options', with that value as +modified by (*UTF) etc in cb->external_options. The extra option +PCRE2_EXTRA_ALLOW_SURROGATE_ESCAPES is not permitted in UTF-16 mode because the +surrogate code points cannot be represented in UTF-16. */ + +utf = (cb.external_options & PCRE2_UTF) != 0; +if (utf) + { + if ((options & PCRE2_NEVER_UTF) != 0) + { + errorcode = ERR74; + goto HAD_EARLY_ERROR; + } + if ((options & PCRE2_NO_UTF_CHECK) == 0 && + (errorcode = PRIV(valid_utf)(pattern, patlen, erroroffset)) != 0) + goto HAD_ERROR; /* Offset was set by valid_utf() */ + +#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 16 + if ((ccontext->extra_options & PCRE2_EXTRA_ALLOW_SURROGATE_ESCAPES) != 0) + { + errorcode = ERR91; + goto HAD_EARLY_ERROR; + } +#endif + } + +/* Check UCP lockout. */ + +ucp = (cb.external_options & PCRE2_UCP) != 0; +if (ucp && (cb.external_options & PCRE2_NEVER_UCP) != 0) + { + errorcode = ERR75; + goto HAD_EARLY_ERROR; + } + +/* Process the BSR setting. */ + +if (bsr == 0) bsr = ccontext->bsr_convention; + +/* Process the newline setting. */ + +if (newline == 0) newline = ccontext->newline_convention; +cb.nltype = NLTYPE_FIXED; +switch(newline) + { + case PCRE2_NEWLINE_CR: + cb.nllen = 1; + cb.nl[0] = CHAR_CR; + break; + + case PCRE2_NEWLINE_LF: + cb.nllen = 1; + cb.nl[0] = CHAR_NL; + break; + + case PCRE2_NEWLINE_NUL: + cb.nllen = 1; + cb.nl[0] = CHAR_NUL; + break; + + case PCRE2_NEWLINE_CRLF: + cb.nllen = 2; + cb.nl[0] = CHAR_CR; + cb.nl[1] = CHAR_NL; + break; + + case PCRE2_NEWLINE_ANY: + cb.nltype = NLTYPE_ANY; + break; + + case PCRE2_NEWLINE_ANYCRLF: + cb.nltype = NLTYPE_ANYCRLF; + break; + + default: + errorcode = ERR56; + goto HAD_EARLY_ERROR; + } + +/* Pre-scan the pattern to do two things: (1) Discover the named groups and +their numerical equivalents, so that this information is always available for +the remaining processing. (2) At the same time, parse the pattern and put a +processed version into the parsed_pattern vector. This has escapes interpreted +and comments removed (amongst other things). + +In all but one case, when PCRE2_AUTO_CALLOUT is not set, the number of unsigned +32-bit ints in the parsed pattern is bounded by the length of the pattern plus +one (for the terminator) plus four if PCRE2_EXTRA_WORD or PCRE2_EXTRA_LINE is +set. The exceptional case is when running in 32-bit, non-UTF mode, when literal +characters greater than META_END (0x80000000) have to be coded as two units. In +this case, therefore, we scan the pattern to check for such values. */ + +#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 32 +if (!utf) + { + PCRE2_SPTR p; + for (p = ptr; p < cb.end_pattern; p++) if (*p >= META_END) big32count++; + } +#endif + +/* Ensure that the parsed pattern buffer is big enough. When PCRE2_AUTO_CALLOUT +is set we have to assume a numerical callout (4 elements) for each character +plus one at the end. This is overkill, but memory is plentiful these days. For +many smaller patterns the vector on the stack (which was set up above) can be +used. */ + +parsed_size_needed = patlen - skipatstart + big32count; + +if ((ccontext->extra_options & + (PCRE2_EXTRA_MATCH_WORD|PCRE2_EXTRA_MATCH_LINE)) != 0) + parsed_size_needed += 4; + +if ((options & PCRE2_AUTO_CALLOUT) != 0) + parsed_size_needed = (parsed_size_needed + 1) * 5; + +if (parsed_size_needed >= PARSED_PATTERN_DEFAULT_SIZE) + { + uint32_t *heap_parsed_pattern = ccontext->memctl.malloc( + (parsed_size_needed + 1) * sizeof(uint32_t), ccontext->memctl.memory_data); + if (heap_parsed_pattern == NULL) + { + *errorptr = ERR21; + goto EXIT; + } + cb.parsed_pattern = heap_parsed_pattern; + } +cb.parsed_pattern_end = cb.parsed_pattern + parsed_size_needed + 1; + +/* Do the parsing scan. */ + +errorcode = parse_regex(ptr, cb.external_options, &has_lookbehind, &cb); +if (errorcode != 0) goto HAD_CB_ERROR; + +/* Workspace is needed to remember information about numbered groups: whether a +group can match an empty string and what its fixed length is. This is done to +avoid the possibility of recursive references causing very long compile times +when checking these features. Unnumbered groups do not have this exposure since +they cannot be referenced. We use an indexed vector for this purpose. If there +are sufficiently few groups, the default vector on the stack, as set up above, +can be used. Otherwise we have to get/free a special vector. The vector must be +initialized to zero. */ + +if (cb.bracount >= GROUPINFO_DEFAULT_SIZE) + { + cb.groupinfo = ccontext->memctl.malloc( + (cb.bracount + 1)*sizeof(uint32_t), ccontext->memctl.memory_data); + if (cb.groupinfo == NULL) + { + errorcode = ERR21; + cb.erroroffset = 0; + goto HAD_CB_ERROR; + } + } +memset(cb.groupinfo, 0, (cb.bracount + 1) * sizeof(uint32_t)); + +/* If there were any lookbehinds, scan the parsed pattern to figure out their +lengths. */ + +if (has_lookbehind) + { + int loopcount = 0; + errorcode = check_lookbehinds(cb.parsed_pattern, NULL, NULL, &cb, &loopcount); + if (errorcode != 0) goto HAD_CB_ERROR; + } + +/* For debugging, there is a function that shows the parsed data vector. */ + +#ifdef DEBUG_SHOW_PARSED +fprintf(stderr, "+++ Pre-scan complete:\n"); +show_parsed(&cb); +#endif + +/* For debugging capturing information this code can be enabled. */ + +#ifdef DEBUG_SHOW_CAPTURES + { + named_group *ng = cb.named_groups; + fprintf(stderr, "+++Captures: %d\n", cb.bracount); + for (i = 0; i < cb.names_found; i++, ng++) + { + fprintf(stderr, "+++%3d %.*s\n", ng->number, ng->length, ng->name); + } + } +#endif + +/* Pretend to compile the pattern while actually just accumulating the amount +of memory required in the 'length' variable. This behaviour is triggered by +passing a non-NULL final argument to compile_regex(). We pass a block of +workspace (cworkspace) for it to compile parts of the pattern into; the +compiled code is discarded when it is no longer needed, so hopefully this +workspace will never overflow, though there is a test for its doing so. + +On error, errorcode will be set non-zero, so we don't need to look at the +result of the function. The initial options have been put into the cb block, +but we still have to pass a separate options variable (the first argument) +because the options may change as the pattern is processed. */ + +cb.erroroffset = patlen; /* For any subsequent errors that do not set it */ +pptr = cb.parsed_pattern; +code = cworkspace; +*code = OP_BRA; + +(void)compile_regex(cb.external_options, &code, &pptr, &errorcode, 0, &firstcu, + &firstcuflags, &reqcu, &reqcuflags, NULL, &cb, &length); + +if (errorcode != 0) goto HAD_CB_ERROR; /* Offset is in cb.erroroffset */ + +/* This should be caught in compile_regex(), but just in case... */ + +if (length > MAX_PATTERN_SIZE) + { + errorcode = ERR20; + goto HAD_CB_ERROR; + } + +/* Compute the size of, and then get and initialize, the data block for storing +the compiled pattern and names table. Integer overflow should no longer be +possible because nowadays we limit the maximum value of cb.names_found and +cb.name_entry_size. */ + +re_blocksize = sizeof(pcre2_real_code) + + CU2BYTES(length + + (PCRE2_SIZE)cb.names_found * (PCRE2_SIZE)cb.name_entry_size); +re = (pcre2_real_code *) + ccontext->memctl.malloc(re_blocksize, ccontext->memctl.memory_data); +if (re == NULL) + { + errorcode = ERR21; + goto HAD_CB_ERROR; + } + +/* The compiler may put padding at the end of the pcre2_real_code structure in +order to round it up to a multiple of 4 or 8 bytes. This means that when a +compiled pattern is copied (for example, when serialized) undefined bytes are +read, and this annoys debuggers such as valgrind. To avoid this, we explicitly +write to the last 8 bytes of the structure before setting the fields. */ + +memset((char *)re + sizeof(pcre2_real_code) - 8, 0, 8); +re->memctl = ccontext->memctl; +re->tables = tables; +re->executable_jit = NULL; +memset(re->start_bitmap, 0, 32 * sizeof(uint8_t)); +re->blocksize = re_blocksize; +re->magic_number = MAGIC_NUMBER; +re->compile_options = options; +re->overall_options = cb.external_options; +re->extra_options = ccontext->extra_options; +re->flags = PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH/8 | cb.external_flags | setflags; +re->limit_heap = limit_heap; +re->limit_match = limit_match; +re->limit_depth = limit_depth; +re->first_codeunit = 0; +re->last_codeunit = 0; +re->bsr_convention = bsr; +re->newline_convention = newline; +re->max_lookbehind = 0; +re->minlength = 0; +re->top_bracket = 0; +re->top_backref = 0; +re->name_entry_size = cb.name_entry_size; +re->name_count = cb.names_found; + +/* The basic block is immediately followed by the name table, and the compiled +code follows after that. */ + +codestart = (PCRE2_SPTR)((uint8_t *)re + sizeof(pcre2_real_code)) + + re->name_entry_size * re->name_count; + +/* Update the compile data block for the actual compile. The starting points of +the name/number translation table and of the code are passed around in the +compile data block. The start/end pattern and initial options are already set +from the pre-compile phase, as is the name_entry_size field. */ + +cb.parens_depth = 0; +cb.assert_depth = 0; +cb.lastcapture = 0; +cb.name_table = (PCRE2_UCHAR *)((uint8_t *)re + sizeof(pcre2_real_code)); +cb.start_code = codestart; +cb.req_varyopt = 0; +cb.had_accept = FALSE; +cb.had_pruneorskip = FALSE; +cb.open_caps = NULL; + +/* If any named groups were found, create the name/number table from the list +created in the pre-pass. */ + +if (cb.names_found > 0) + { + named_group *ng = cb.named_groups; + for (i = 0; i < cb.names_found; i++, ng++) + add_name_to_table(&cb, ng->name, ng->length, ng->number, i); + } + +/* Set up a starting, non-extracting bracket, then compile the expression. On +error, errorcode will be set non-zero, so we don't need to look at the result +of the function here. */ + +pptr = cb.parsed_pattern; +code = (PCRE2_UCHAR *)codestart; +*code = OP_BRA; +regexrc = compile_regex(re->overall_options, &code, &pptr, &errorcode, 0, + &firstcu, &firstcuflags, &reqcu, &reqcuflags, NULL, &cb, NULL); +if (regexrc < 0) re->flags |= PCRE2_MATCH_EMPTY; +re->top_bracket = cb.bracount; +re->top_backref = cb.top_backref; +re->max_lookbehind = cb.max_lookbehind; + +if (cb.had_accept) + { + reqcu = 0; /* Must disable after (*ACCEPT) */ + reqcuflags = REQ_NONE; + re->flags |= PCRE2_HASACCEPT; /* Disables minimum length */ + } + +/* Fill in the final opcode and check for disastrous overflow. If no overflow, +but the estimated length exceeds the really used length, adjust the value of +re->blocksize, and if valgrind support is configured, mark the extra allocated +memory as unaddressable, so that any out-of-bound reads can be detected. */ + +*code++ = OP_END; +usedlength = code - codestart; +if (usedlength > length) errorcode = ERR23; else + { + re->blocksize -= CU2BYTES(length - usedlength); +#ifdef SUPPORT_VALGRIND + VALGRIND_MAKE_MEM_NOACCESS(code, CU2BYTES(length - usedlength)); +#endif + } + +/* Scan the pattern for recursion/subroutine calls and convert the group +numbers into offsets. Maintain a small cache so that repeated groups containing +recursions are efficiently handled. */ + +#define RSCAN_CACHE_SIZE 8 + +if (errorcode == 0 && cb.had_recurse) + { + PCRE2_UCHAR *rcode; + PCRE2_SPTR rgroup; + unsigned int ccount = 0; + int start = RSCAN_CACHE_SIZE; + recurse_cache rc[RSCAN_CACHE_SIZE]; + + for (rcode = (PCRE2_UCHAR *)find_recurse(codestart, utf); + rcode != NULL; + rcode = (PCRE2_UCHAR *)find_recurse(rcode + 1 + LINK_SIZE, utf)) + { + int p, groupnumber; + + groupnumber = (int)GET(rcode, 1); + if (groupnumber == 0) rgroup = codestart; else + { + PCRE2_SPTR search_from = codestart; + rgroup = NULL; + for (i = 0, p = start; i < ccount; i++, p = (p + 1) & 7) + { + if (groupnumber == rc[p].groupnumber) + { + rgroup = rc[p].group; + break; + } + + /* Group n+1 must always start to the right of group n, so we can save + search time below when the new group number is greater than any of the + previously found groups. */ + + if (groupnumber > rc[p].groupnumber) search_from = rc[p].group; + } + + if (rgroup == NULL) + { + rgroup = PRIV(find_bracket)(search_from, utf, groupnumber); + if (rgroup == NULL) + { + errorcode = ERR53; + break; + } + if (--start < 0) start = RSCAN_CACHE_SIZE - 1; + rc[start].groupnumber = groupnumber; + rc[start].group = rgroup; + if (ccount < RSCAN_CACHE_SIZE) ccount++; + } + } + + PUT(rcode, 1, rgroup - codestart); + } + } + +/* In rare debugging situations we sometimes need to look at the compiled code +at this stage. */ + +#ifdef DEBUG_CALL_PRINTINT +pcre2_printint(re, stderr, TRUE); +fprintf(stderr, "Length=%lu Used=%lu\n", length, usedlength); +#endif + +/* Unless disabled, check whether any single character iterators can be +auto-possessified. The function overwrites the appropriate opcode values, so +the type of the pointer must be cast. NOTE: the intermediate variable "temp" is +used in this code because at least one compiler gives a warning about loss of +"const" attribute if the cast (PCRE2_UCHAR *)codestart is used directly in the +function call. */ + +if (errorcode == 0 && (re->overall_options & PCRE2_NO_AUTO_POSSESS) == 0) + { + PCRE2_UCHAR *temp = (PCRE2_UCHAR *)codestart; + if (PRIV(auto_possessify)(temp, &cb) != 0) errorcode = ERR80; + } + +/* Failed to compile, or error while post-processing. */ + +if (errorcode != 0) goto HAD_CB_ERROR; + +/* Successful compile. If the anchored option was not passed, set it if +we can determine that the pattern is anchored by virtue of ^ characters or \A +or anything else, such as starting with non-atomic .* when DOTALL is set and +there are no occurrences of *PRUNE or *SKIP (though there is an option to +disable this case). */ + +if ((re->overall_options & PCRE2_ANCHORED) == 0 && + is_anchored(codestart, 0, &cb, 0, FALSE)) + re->overall_options |= PCRE2_ANCHORED; + +/* Set up the first code unit or startline flag, the required code unit, and +then study the pattern. This code need not be obeyed if PCRE2_NO_START_OPTIMIZE +is set, as the data it would create will not be used. Note that a first code +unit (but not the startline flag) is useful for anchored patterns because it +can still give a quick "no match" and also avoid searching for a last code +unit. */ + +if ((re->overall_options & PCRE2_NO_START_OPTIMIZE) == 0) + { + int minminlength = 0; /* For minimal minlength from first/required CU */ + + /* If we do not have a first code unit, see if there is one that is asserted + (these are not saved during the compile because they can cause conflicts with + actual literals that follow). */ + + if (firstcuflags >= REQ_NONE) + firstcu = find_firstassertedcu(codestart, &firstcuflags, 0); + + /* Save the data for a first code unit. The existence of one means the + minimum length must be at least 1. */ + + if (firstcuflags < REQ_NONE) + { + re->first_codeunit = firstcu; + re->flags |= PCRE2_FIRSTSET; + minminlength++; + + /* Handle caseless first code units. */ + + if ((firstcuflags & REQ_CASELESS) != 0) + { + if (firstcu < 128 || (!utf && !ucp && firstcu < 255)) + { + if (cb.fcc[firstcu] != firstcu) re->flags |= PCRE2_FIRSTCASELESS; + } + + /* The first code unit is > 128 in UTF or UCP mode, or > 255 otherwise. + In 8-bit UTF mode, codepoints in the range 128-255 are introductory code + points and cannot have another case, but if UCP is set they may do. */ + +#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE +#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 8 + else if (ucp && !utf && UCD_OTHERCASE(firstcu) != firstcu) + re->flags |= PCRE2_FIRSTCASELESS; +#else + else if ((utf || ucp) && firstcu <= MAX_UTF_CODE_POINT && + UCD_OTHERCASE(firstcu) != firstcu) + re->flags |= PCRE2_FIRSTCASELESS; +#endif +#endif /* SUPPORT_UNICODE */ + } + } + + /* When there is no first code unit, for non-anchored patterns, see if we can + set the PCRE2_STARTLINE flag. This is helpful for multiline matches when all + branches start with ^ and also when all branches start with non-atomic .* for + non-DOTALL matches when *PRUNE and SKIP are not present. (There is an option + that disables this case.) */ + + else if ((re->overall_options & PCRE2_ANCHORED) == 0 && + is_startline(codestart, 0, &cb, 0, FALSE)) + re->flags |= PCRE2_STARTLINE; + + /* Handle the "required code unit", if one is set. In the UTF case we can + increment the minimum minimum length only if we are sure this really is a + different character and not a non-starting code unit of the first character, + because the minimum length count is in characters, not code units. */ + + if (reqcuflags < REQ_NONE) + { +#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 16 + if ((re->overall_options & PCRE2_UTF) == 0 || /* Not UTF */ + firstcuflags >= REQ_NONE || /* First not set */ + (firstcu & 0xf800) != 0xd800 || /* First not surrogate */ + (reqcu & 0xfc00) != 0xdc00) /* Req not low surrogate */ +#elif PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 8 + if ((re->overall_options & PCRE2_UTF) == 0 || /* Not UTF */ + firstcuflags >= REQ_NONE || /* First not set */ + (firstcu & 0x80) == 0 || /* First is ASCII */ + (reqcu & 0x80) == 0) /* Req is ASCII */ +#endif + { + minminlength++; + } + + /* In the case of an anchored pattern, set up the value only if it follows + a variable length item in the pattern. */ + + if ((re->overall_options & PCRE2_ANCHORED) == 0 || + (reqcuflags & REQ_VARY) != 0) + { + re->last_codeunit = reqcu; + re->flags |= PCRE2_LASTSET; + + /* Handle caseless required code units as for first code units (above). */ + + if ((reqcuflags & REQ_CASELESS) != 0) + { + if (reqcu < 128 || (!utf && !ucp && reqcu < 255)) + { + if (cb.fcc[reqcu] != reqcu) re->flags |= PCRE2_LASTCASELESS; + } +#ifdef SUPPORT_UNICODE +#if PCRE2_CODE_UNIT_WIDTH == 8 + else if (ucp && !utf && UCD_OTHERCASE(reqcu) != reqcu) + re->flags |= PCRE2_LASTCASELESS; +#else + else if ((utf || ucp) && reqcu <= MAX_UTF_CODE_POINT && + UCD_OTHERCASE(reqcu) != reqcu) + re->flags |= PCRE2_LASTCASELESS; +#endif +#endif /* SUPPORT_UNICODE */ + } + } + } + + /* Study the compiled pattern to set up information such as a bitmap of + starting code units and a minimum matching length. */ + + if (PRIV(study)(re) != 0) + { + errorcode = ERR31; + goto HAD_CB_ERROR; + } + + /* If study() set a bitmap of starting code units, it implies a minimum + length of at least one. */ + + if ((re->flags & PCRE2_FIRSTMAPSET) != 0 && minminlength == 0) + minminlength = 1; + + /* If the minimum length set (or not set) by study() is less than the minimum + implied by required code units, override it. */ + + if (re->minlength < minminlength) re->minlength = minminlength; + } /* End of start-of-match optimizations. */ + +/* Control ends up here in all cases. When running under valgrind, make a +pattern's terminating zero defined again. If memory was obtained for the parsed +version of the pattern, free it before returning. Also free the list of named +groups if a larger one had to be obtained, and likewise the group information +vector. */ + +EXIT: +#ifdef SUPPORT_VALGRIND +if (zero_terminated) VALGRIND_MAKE_MEM_DEFINED(pattern + patlen, CU2BYTES(1)); +#endif +if (cb.parsed_pattern != stack_parsed_pattern) + ccontext->memctl.free(cb.parsed_pattern, ccontext->memctl.memory_data); +if (cb.named_group_list_size > NAMED_GROUP_LIST_SIZE) + ccontext->memctl.free((void *)cb.named_groups, ccontext->memctl.memory_data); +if (cb.groupinfo != stack_groupinfo) + ccontext->memctl.free((void *)cb.groupinfo, ccontext->memctl.memory_data); +return re; /* Will be NULL after an error */ + +/* Errors discovered in parse_regex() set the offset value in the compile +block. Errors discovered before it is called must compute it from the ptr +value. After parse_regex() is called, the offset in the compile block is set to +the end of the pattern, but certain errors in compile_regex() may reset it if +an offset is available in the parsed pattern. */ + +HAD_CB_ERROR: +ptr = pattern + cb.erroroffset; + +HAD_EARLY_ERROR: +*erroroffset = ptr - pattern; + +HAD_ERROR: +*errorptr = errorcode; +pcre2_code_free(re); +re = NULL; +goto EXIT; +} + +/* These #undefs are here to enable unity builds with CMake. */ + +#undef NLBLOCK /* Block containing newline information */ +#undef PSSTART /* Field containing processed string start */ +#undef PSEND /* Field containing processed string end */ + +/* End of pcre2_compile.c */ |